9f78ae4a46aee60e98d73f3fa0a97e7d7d3037eb
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
36 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
37 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
38 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
39 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
40 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
41 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
42 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
43 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
44 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
45 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
46 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
47 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
48 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
49 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
50 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
51 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
52 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
53 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
54 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
55 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
56 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
57 * Misc:: Everything else.
58 @end menu
59
60 @node Target Structure
61 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
62 @cindex target hooks
63 @cindex target functions
64
65 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
66 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
67 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
68 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
69 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
70 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
71 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
72 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
73 @smallexample
74 #include "target.h"
75 #include "target-def.h"
76
77 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
78
79 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
80 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
81
82 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
83 @end smallexample
84 @end deftypevar
85
86 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
87 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
88 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
89 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
90 @code{targetm} structure.
91
92 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
93 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
94 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
95 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
96 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
97 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
98 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
99
100 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
101 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
102 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
103 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
104 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
105 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
106 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
107 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
108 default definition is used.
109
110 @node Driver
111 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
112 @cindex driver
113 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
114
115 @c prevent bad page break with this line
116 You can control the compilation driver.
117
118 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
119 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
120 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
121
122 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
123 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
124 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
125 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
126 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
127 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
128
129 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
130 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
131 that the other specs are easier to write.
132
133 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
134 @end defmac
135
136 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
137 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
138 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
139 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
140 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
141
142 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
143 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
144 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
145 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
146 everywhere it occurs.
147
148 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
149 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
150 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
151
152 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
153 @end defmac
154
155 @defmac CPP_SPEC
156 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
157 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
158 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
159
160 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
161 @end defmac
162
163 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
164 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
165 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
166 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
167 @end defmac
168
169 @defmac CC1_SPEC
170 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
171 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
172 front ends.
173 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
174 for GCC to pass to front ends.
175
176 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
177 @end defmac
178
179 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
180 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
181 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
182 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
183
184 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
185 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
186 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
187 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
188 @end defmac
189
190 @defmac ASM_SPEC
191 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
192 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
193 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
194 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
195
196 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
197 @end defmac
198
199 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
200 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
201 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
202 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
203 an example of this.
204
205 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
206 @end defmac
207
208 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
209 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
210 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
211 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
212 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
213 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
214
215 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
216 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
217 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
218 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
219 @end defmac
220
221 @defmac LINK_SPEC
222 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
223 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
224 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
225
226 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
227 @end defmac
228
229 @defmac LIB_SPEC
230 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
231 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
232 command given to the linker.
233
234 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
235 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
236 @end defmac
237
238 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
239 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
240 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
241 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
242 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
243
244 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
245 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
246 @end defmac
247
248 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
249 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
250 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
251 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
252 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
253 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
254 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
255 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
256 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
257 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
258 @end defmac
259
260 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
261 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
262 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
263 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
264 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273 @end defmac
274
275 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
276 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
290 @end defmac
291
292 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
293 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
300 @end defmac
301
302 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
303 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
306 @end defmac
307
308 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
309 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
311 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
312 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
313 @end defmac
314
315 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
316 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322 string constant that provides the specification.
323
324 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
327 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
328 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329 these definitions.
330
331 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334 used.
335
336 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
338 @smallexample
339 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
343 @end smallexample
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346 @smallexample
347 #undef CPP_SPEC
348 #define CPP_SPEC \
349 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
350 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
352 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356 @end smallexample
357
358 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361 @smallexample
362 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364 @end smallexample
365 @end defmac
366
367 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
368 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
370 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
371 @end defmac
372
373 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376 @end defmac
377
378 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
379 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
380 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
381 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
382 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
383 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
384 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
385 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
386 @end defmac
387
388 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
389 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
390 @end deftypevr
391
392 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
393 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
394 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
395 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
396 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
397
398 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
399 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
400 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
401 @xref{Target Fragment}.
402 @end defmac
403
404 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
405 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
406 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
407 indicates an absolute file name.
408 @end defmac
409
410 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
411 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
412 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
413 when the compiler is built as a cross
414 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
415 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
416 @end defmac
417
418 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
419 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
420 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
421 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
422 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
423 is built as a cross compiler.
424 @end defmac
425
426 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
427 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
429 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
431 is built as a cross compiler.
432 @end defmac
433
434 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
435 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
437 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
439 is built as a cross compiler.
440 @end defmac
441
442 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
443 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
444 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
445 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
446 @end defmac
447
448 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
449 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
450 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
451 cross compiler.
452 @end defmac
453
454 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
455 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
456 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
457 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
458 initialize the necessary environment variables.
459 @end defmac
460
461 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
462 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
463 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
464 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
465 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
466 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
467
468 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
469 replacement.
470 @end defmac
471
472 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
473 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
474 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
475 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
476 @end defmac
477
478 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
479 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
480 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
481 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
482 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
483 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
484 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
485 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
486 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
487
488 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
489 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
490 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
491 for C++-only directories,
492 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
493 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
494 the array with a null element.
495
496 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
497 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
498 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
499 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
500
501 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
502
503 @smallexample
504 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
505 @{ \
506 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
507 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
508 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
509 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
511 @}
512 @end smallexample
513 @end defmac
514
515 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
516
517 @enumerate
518 @item
519 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
520
521 @item
522 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
523 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
524 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
525
526 @item
527 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
528
529 @item
530 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
531 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
532
533 @item
534 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
535
536 @item
537 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
538
539 @item
540 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
541 compiler.
542 @end enumerate
543
544 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
545
546 @enumerate
547 @item
548 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
549
550 @item
551 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
552 value based on the installed toolchain location.
553
554 @item
555 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
556 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
557
558 @item
559 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
560 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
561
562 @item
563 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
564
565 @item
566 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
567 compiler.
568
569 @item
570 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
571 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
572
573 @item
574 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
575 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
576
577 @item
578 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
579 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
580 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
581
582 @item
583 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
584 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
585 @file{/lib/}.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
589 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590 @file{/usr/lib/}.
591 @end enumerate
592
593 @node Run-time Target
594 @section Run-time Target Specification
595 @cindex run-time target specification
596 @cindex predefined macros
597 @cindex target specifications
598
599 @c prevent bad page break with this line
600 Here are run-time target specifications.
601
602 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
603 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
604 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
605 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
606 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
607 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
608 finished command line option processing your code can use those
609 results freely.
610
611 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
612 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
613 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
614 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
615
616 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
617 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
618 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
619 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
620 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
621 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
622 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
623 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
624 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
625 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
626
627 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
628 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
629 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
630 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
631 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
632 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
633 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
634 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
635 preprocessing.
636 @end defmac
637
638 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
639 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
640 and is used for the target operating system instead.
641 @end defmac
642
643 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
646 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
647 it yourself.
648 @end defmac
649
650 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
651 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
652 any target-specific headers.
653 @end deftypevar
654
655 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
656 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
657 Its default setting is 0.
658 @end deftypevr
659
660 @cindex optional hardware or system features
661 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
662
663 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
664 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
665 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
666 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
667 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
668 definition does nothing but return true.
669
670 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
671 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
672 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
673 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
674 via attributes).
675 @end deftypefn
676
677 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
678 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
679 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
680 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
681 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
682 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
683 default definition does nothing but return false.
684
685 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
686 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
687 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
688 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
689 @end deftypefn
690
691 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
692 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
693 @end deftypefn
694
695 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
696 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
697 @end deftypefn
698
699 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
700 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
701 @end deftypefn
702
703 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
704 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
705 @end deftypefn
706
707 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
708 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
709 @end deftypefn
710
711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
712 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
713 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
714 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
715 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
716 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
717 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
718 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
719 @end deftypefn
720
721 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
722 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
723 but is only used in the C
724 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
725 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
726 frontends.
727 @end defmac
728
729 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
730 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
731 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
732 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
733 options are processed once
734 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
735 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
736 options passed explicitly.
737
738 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
739 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
740 @code{optimize} attribute.
741 @end deftypevr
742
743 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
744 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
745 @end deftypefn
746
747 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
748 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
749 @end deftypefn
750
751 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
752 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
753 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
754 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
755 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
756 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
757
758 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
759 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
760 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
761 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
762 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
763 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
764 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
765
766 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
767 is 0.
768 @end defmac
769
770 @node Per-Function Data
771 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
772 @cindex per-function data
773 @cindex data structures
774
775 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
776 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
777 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
778 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
779 when another one comes along.
780
781 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
782 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
783 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
784 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
785 to their own specific data.
786
787 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
788 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
789 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
790 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
791
792 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
793 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
794 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
795 function, for level 0.
796
797 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
798 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
799 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
800 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
801 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
802 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
803 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
804 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
805 longer supported.
806
807 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
808 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
809 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
810 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
811 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
812 @end defmac
813
814 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
815 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
816 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
817 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
818 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
819 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
820
821 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
822 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
823 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
824 @end deftypevar
825
826 @node Storage Layout
827 @section Storage Layout
828 @cindex storage layout
829
830 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
831 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
832 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
833 @xref{Run-time Target}.
834
835 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
836 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
837 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
838 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
839 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
840 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
841 macro need not be a constant.
842
843 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
844 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
845 @end defmac
846
847 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
848 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
849 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
850 @end defmac
851
852 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
853 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
854 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
855 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
856 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
857 macro need not be a constant.
858 @end defmac
859
860 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
861 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
862 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
863 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
864 the order of words in memory.
865 @end defmac
866
867 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
868 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
869 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
870 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
871 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
872
873 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
874 multi-word integers.
875 @end defmac
876
877 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
878 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
879 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
880 @end defmac
881
882 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
883 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
884 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
885 @end defmac
886
887 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
888 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
889 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
890 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
891 @end defmac
892
893 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
894 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
895 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
896 @end defmac
897
898 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
899 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
900 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
901 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
902 @end defmac
903
904 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
905 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
906 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
907 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
908 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
909 @end defmac
910
911 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
912 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
913 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
914 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
915 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
916 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
917 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
918
919 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
920 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
921 @end defmac
922
923 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
924 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
925 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
926 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
927 scalar type.
928
929 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
930 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
931 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
932 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
933 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
934 counterparts.
935
936 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
937 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
938 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
939 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
940 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
941 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
942
943 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
944 @end defmac
945
946 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
947 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
948 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
949 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
950 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
951 pointer} types.
952
953 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
954 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
955 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
956 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
957 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
958 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
959 the signedness may be different.
960
961 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
962
963 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
964 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
965 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
966 @end deftypefn
967
968 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
969 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
970 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
971 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
972 size of an integer.
973 @end defmac
974
975 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
976 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
977 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
978 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
979 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
980 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
981 @end defmac
982
983 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
984 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
985 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
986 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
987 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
988 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
989 @end defmac
990
991 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
992 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
993 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
994 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
995 @end defmac
996
997 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
998 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
999 @end defmac
1000
1001 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1002 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1003 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1004 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1005 @end defmac
1006
1007 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1008 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1009 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1010 @end defmac
1011
1012 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1013 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1014 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1015 @end defmac
1016
1017 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1018 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1019 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1020 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1021 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1022 @end defmac
1023
1024 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1025 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1026 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1027 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1028 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1029 @end defmac
1030
1031 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1032 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1033 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1034 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1035 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1036 field alignment has not been set by the
1037 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1038 @end defmac
1039
1040 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1041 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1042 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1043
1044 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1045
1046 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1047 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1048 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1049 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1050 @end defmac
1051
1052 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1053 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1054 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1055 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1056 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1057
1058 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1059 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1060 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1061 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1062 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1063 @end defmac
1064
1065 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1066 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1067 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1068 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1069 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1070
1071 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1072
1073 @findex strcpy
1074 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1075 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1076 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1077 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1078 @end defmac
1079
1080 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1081 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1082 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1083 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1084 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1085 align the object.
1086
1087 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1088
1089 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1090 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1091 constants can be done inline.
1092 @end defmac
1093
1094 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1095 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1096 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1097 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1098 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1099
1100 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1101
1102 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1103 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1104
1105 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1106 @end defmac
1107
1108 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1109 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1110 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1111 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1112 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1113 the vector element type.
1114 @end deftypefn
1115
1116 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1117 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1118 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1119 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1120 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1121 align the slot.
1122
1123 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1124 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1125 be used.
1126
1127 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1128 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1129
1130 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1131 @end defmac
1132
1133 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1134 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1135 variable @var{decl}.
1136
1137 If this macro is not defined, then
1138 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1139 is used.
1140
1141 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1142 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1143
1144 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1145 @end defmac
1146
1147 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1148 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1149 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1150 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1151
1152 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1153 @end defmac
1154
1155 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1156 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1157 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1158
1159 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1160 @end defmac
1161
1162 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1163 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1164 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1165
1166 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1167 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1168 @end defmac
1169
1170 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1171 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1172 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1173 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1174 @end defmac
1175
1176 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1177 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1178 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1179
1180 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1181 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1182 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1183 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1184 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1185
1186 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1187 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1188 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1189 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1190
1191 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1192 structure.
1193
1194 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1195 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1196
1197 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1198 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1199 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1200 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1201
1202 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1203 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1204 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1205
1206 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1207 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1208 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1209
1210 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1211 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1212 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1213
1214 @smallexample
1215 struct foo1
1216 @{
1217 char x;
1218 char :0;
1219 char y;
1220 @};
1221
1222 struct foo2
1223 @{
1224 char x;
1225 int :0;
1226 char y;
1227 @};
1228
1229 main ()
1230 @{
1231 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1232 sizeof (struct foo1));
1233 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1234 sizeof (struct foo2));
1235 exit (0);
1236 @}
1237 @end smallexample
1238
1239 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1240 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1241 @end defmac
1242
1243 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1244 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1245 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1246 @end defmac
1247
1248 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1249 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1250 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1251 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1252 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1253 @end deftypefn
1254
1255 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1256 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1257 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1258 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1259
1260 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1261 @end deftypefn
1262
1263 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
1264 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1265 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1266
1267 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1268 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1269 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1270 retain the field's mode.
1271
1272 Normally, this is not needed.
1273 @end deftypefn
1274
1275 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1276 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1277 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1278 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1279 @var{specified}.
1280
1281 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1282 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1283 @end defmac
1284
1285 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1286 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1287 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1288 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1289 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1290 (DImode)} is assumed.
1291 @end defmac
1292
1293 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1294 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1295 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1296 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1297 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1298 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1299 having its mode specified.
1300
1301 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1302 would most commonly define this macro if the
1303 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1304 64-bit mode.
1305 @end defmac
1306
1307 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1308 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1309 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1310 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1311
1312 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1313 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1314 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1315 @end defmac
1316
1317 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1318 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1319 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1320 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1321 targets.
1322 @end deftypefn
1323
1324 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1325 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1326 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1327 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1328 targets.
1329 @end deftypefn
1330
1331 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1332 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1333 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1334 @end deftypefn
1335
1336 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1337 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1338 mode is towards zero.
1339
1340 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1341 floating-point arithmetic.
1342
1343 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1344 @end defmac
1345
1346 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1347 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1348 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1349 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1350
1351 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1352 floating-point arithmetic.
1353
1354 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1355 @end defmac
1356
1357 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1358 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1359 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1360 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1361 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1362 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1363 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1364 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1365 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1366 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1367 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1368 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1369
1370 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1371 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1372 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1373 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1374 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1375 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1376 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1377
1378 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1379 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1380 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1381 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1382 may affect its placement.
1383 @end deftypefn
1384
1385 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1386 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1387 @end deftypefn
1388
1389 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1390 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1391 @end deftypefn
1392
1393 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1394 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1395 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1396 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1397 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1398 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1399 usage.
1400 @end deftypefn
1401
1402 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1403 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1404 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1405 @end deftypefn
1406
1407 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1408 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1409 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1410 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1411 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1412 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1413 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1414 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1415 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1416 string constant.
1417
1418 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1419 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1420 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1421 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1422 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1423 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1424 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1425 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1426 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1427 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1428 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1429 spaces in your string.
1430
1431 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1432 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1433 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1434 before mangling.
1435
1436 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1437 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1438 types.
1439 @end deftypefn
1440
1441 @node Type Layout
1442 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1443
1444 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1445 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1446 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1447 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1448
1449 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1450 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1451 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1452 @end defmac
1453
1454 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1455 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1456 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1457 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1458 unit.)
1459 @end defmac
1460
1461 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1462 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1463 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1464 @end defmac
1465
1466 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1467 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1468 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1469 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1470 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1471 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1472 @end defmac
1473
1474 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1475 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1476 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1477 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1478 macro must be at least 64.
1479 @end defmac
1480
1481 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1482 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1483 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1484 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1485 @end defmac
1486
1487 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1488 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1489 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1490 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1491 @end defmac
1492
1493 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1494 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1495 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1496 @end defmac
1497
1498 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1499 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1500 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1501 words.
1502 @end defmac
1503
1504 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1505 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1506 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1507 words.
1508 @end defmac
1509
1510 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1511 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1512 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1513 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1514 @end defmac
1515
1516 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1517 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1518 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1519 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1520 @end defmac
1521
1522 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1523 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1524 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1525 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1526 @end defmac
1527
1528 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1529 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1530 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1531 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1532 @end defmac
1533
1534 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1535 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1536 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1537 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1538 @end defmac
1539
1540 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1541 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1542 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1543 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1544 @end defmac
1545
1546 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1547 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1548 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1549 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1550 @end defmac
1551
1552 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1553 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1554 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1555 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1556 @end defmac
1557
1558 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1559 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1560 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1561 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1562 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1563 @end defmac
1564
1565 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1566 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1567 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1568 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1569 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1570 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1571 otherwise it is 0.
1572 @end defmac
1573
1574 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1575 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1576 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1577 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1578 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1579 @end defmac
1580
1581 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1582 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1583 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1584 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1585 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1586 @end defmac
1587
1588 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1589 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1590 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1591 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1592 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1593 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1594 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1595 @end defmac
1596
1597 @defmac SF_SIZE
1598 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1599 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1600 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1601 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1602 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1603 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1604 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1605 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1606 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1607 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1608 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1609 @end defmac
1610
1611 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1612 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1613 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1614 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1615 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1616 @end defmac
1617
1618 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1619 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1620 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1621 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1622 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1623 is the default.
1624 @end defmac
1625
1626 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1627 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1628 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1629 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1630 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1631 @end defmac
1632
1633 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1634 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1635 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1636 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1637 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1638
1639 The default is to return false.
1640 @end deftypefn
1641
1642 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1643 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1644 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1645 contents of the string.
1646
1647 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1648 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1649 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1650 of the data type names defined in the function
1651 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1652 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1653 compiler to crash on startup.
1654
1655 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1656 int"}.
1657 @end defmac
1658
1659 @defmac SIZETYPE
1660 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1661 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1662 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1663 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1664 is extracted.
1665
1666 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1667
1668 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1669 @end defmac
1670
1671 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1672 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1673 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1674 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1675 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1676
1677 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1678 @end defmac
1679
1680 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1681 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1682 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1683 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1684 information.
1685
1686 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1687 @end defmac
1688
1689 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1690 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1691 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1692 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1693 @end defmac
1694
1695 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1696 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1697 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1698 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1699 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1700 information.
1701
1702 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1703 @end defmac
1704
1705 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1706 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1707 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1708 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1709 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1710
1711 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1712 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1713 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1714 @end defmac
1715
1716 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1717 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1718 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1719 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1720 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1721
1722 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1723 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1724 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1725 int}.
1726 @end defmac
1727
1728 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1729 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1730 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1731 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1732 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1733 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1734 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1735 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1736 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1737 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1738 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1739 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1740 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1741 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1742 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1743 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1744 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1745 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1746 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1747 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1748 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1749 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1750 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1751 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1752 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1753 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1754 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1755 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1756 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1757 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1758 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1759 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1760 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1761 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1762 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1763 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1764 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1765
1766 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1767 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1768 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1769 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1770 these macros are null pointers.
1771 @end defmac
1772
1773 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1774 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1775 that looks like:
1776
1777 @smallexample
1778 struct @{
1779 union @{
1780 void (*fn)();
1781 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1782 @};
1783 ptrdiff_t delta;
1784 @};
1785 @end smallexample
1786
1787 @noindent
1788 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1789 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1790 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1791 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1792 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1793 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1794 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1795 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1796
1797 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1798 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1799 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1800 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1801 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1802 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1803 architecture, you should define this macro to
1804 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1805
1806 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1807 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1808 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1809 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1810 @end defmac
1811
1812 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1813 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1814 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1815 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1816 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1817 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1818 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1819
1820 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1821 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1822 @end defmac
1823
1824 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1825 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1826 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1827 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1828 when special alignment is necessary. */
1829 @end defmac
1830
1831 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1832 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1833 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1834 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1835 of words in each data entry.
1836 @end defmac
1837
1838 @node Registers
1839 @section Register Usage
1840 @cindex register usage
1841
1842 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1843 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1844
1845 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1846 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1847 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1848 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1849 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1850
1851 @menu
1852 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1853 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1854 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1855 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1856 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1857 @end menu
1858
1859 @node Register Basics
1860 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1861
1862 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1863 Registers have various characteristics.
1864
1865 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1866 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1867 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1868 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1869 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1870 @end defmac
1871
1872 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1873 @cindex fixed register
1874 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1875 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1876 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1877 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1878 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1879 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1880 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1881
1882 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1883 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1884 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1885
1886 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1887 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1888 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1889 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1890 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1891 @end defmac
1892
1893 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1894 @cindex call-used register
1895 @cindex call-clobbered register
1896 @cindex call-saved register
1897 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1898 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1899 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1900 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1901 function calls.
1902
1903 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1904 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1905 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1906 @end defmac
1907
1908 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1909 @cindex call-used register
1910 @cindex call-clobbered register
1911 @cindex call-saved register
1912 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1913 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1914 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1915 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1916 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1917 @end defmac
1918
1919 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1920 @cindex call-used register
1921 @cindex call-clobbered register
1922 @cindex call-saved register
1923 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1924 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1925 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1926 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1927 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1928 @end defmac
1929
1930 @findex fixed_regs
1931 @findex call_used_regs
1932 @findex global_regs
1933 @findex reg_names
1934 @findex reg_class_contents
1935 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1936 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1937 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1938 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1939 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1940 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1941 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1942 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1943 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1944 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1945 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1946 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1947 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1948 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1949 command options have been applied.
1950
1951 @cindex disabling certain registers
1952 @cindex controlling register usage
1953 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1954 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1955 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1956 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1957 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1958 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1959 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1960
1961 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1962 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1963 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1964 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1965 @end deftypefn
1966
1967 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1968 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1969 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1970 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1971 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1972 outbound register.
1973 @end defmac
1974
1975 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1976 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1977 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1978 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1979 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1980 register.
1981 @end defmac
1982
1983 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1984 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1985 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1986 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1987 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1988 gotos.
1989 @end defmac
1990
1991 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1992 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1993 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1994 @end defmac
1995
1996 @node Allocation Order
1997 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1998 @cindex order of register allocation
1999 @cindex register allocation order
2000
2001 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2002 Registers are allocated in order.
2003
2004 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2005 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2006 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2007 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2008
2009 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2010 (all else being equal).
2011
2012 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2013 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2014 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2015 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2016 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2017 @end defmac
2018
2019 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2020 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2021 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2022
2023 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2024 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2025 register; and so on.
2026
2027 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2028 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2029
2030 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2031 @end defmac
2032
2033 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2034 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2035 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2036 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2037 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2038 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2039 should be defined.
2040 @end defmac
2041
2042 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2043 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2044 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2045 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2046 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2047 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2048 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2049 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2050
2051 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2052 @end defmac
2053
2054 @node Values in Registers
2055 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2056
2057 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2058 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2059 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2060
2061 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2062 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2063 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2064 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2065 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2066 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2067
2068 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2069 definition of this macro is
2070
2071 @smallexample
2072 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2073 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2074 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2075 @end smallexample
2076 @end defmac
2077
2078 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2079 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2080 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2081 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2082 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2083 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2084 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2085
2086 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2087 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2088 nonzero.
2089
2090 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2091 @code{subreg_get_info}
2092 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2093 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2094 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2095 registers and so not be representable.
2096 @end defmac
2097
2098 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2099 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2100 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2101 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2102 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2103 @end defmac
2104
2105 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2106 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2107 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2108 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2109 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2110 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2111 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2112 @end defmac
2113
2114 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2115 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2116 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2117 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2118 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2119
2120 @smallexample
2121 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2122 @end smallexample
2123
2124 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2125 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2126
2127 @cindex register pairs
2128 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2129 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2130 odd register numbers for such modes.
2131
2132 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2133 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2134 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2135 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2136
2137 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2138 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2139 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2140 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2141 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2142 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2143 to be tieable.
2144
2145 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2146 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2147 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2148 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2149 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2150 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2151
2152 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2153 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2154 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2155 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2156 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2157 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2158 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2159 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2160 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2161
2162 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2163 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2164 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2165 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2166 constraints for those instructions.
2167
2168 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2169 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2170 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2171 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2172 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2173 @end defmac
2174
2175 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2176 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2177 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2178
2179 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2180 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2181 handler.
2182
2183 The default is always nonzero.
2184 @end defmac
2185
2186 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2187 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2188 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2189
2190 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2191 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2192 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2193 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2194 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2195 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2196
2197 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2198 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2199 allocation.
2200 @end defmac
2201
2202 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2203 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2204 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2205
2206 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2207 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2208
2209 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2210 @end deftypefn
2211
2212 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2213 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2214 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2215 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2216 @end defmac
2217
2218 @node Leaf Functions
2219 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2220
2221 @cindex leaf functions
2222 @cindex functions, leaf
2223 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2224 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2225 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2226 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2227 normally arrive.
2228
2229 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2230 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2231 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2232 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2233 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2234 functions''.
2235
2236 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2237 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2238 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2239 accomplish this.
2240
2241 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2242 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2243 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2244 function treatment.
2245
2246 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2247 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2248 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2249 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2250 in this vector.
2251
2252 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2253 the treatment of leaf functions.
2254 @end defmac
2255
2256 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2257 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2258 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2259
2260 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2261 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2262 will cause the compiler to abort.
2263
2264 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2265 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2266 this.
2267 @end defmac
2268
2269 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2270 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2271 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2272 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2273 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2274 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2275 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2276 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2277 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2278 functions which only use leaf registers.
2279 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2280 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2281 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2282 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2283 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2284
2285 @node Stack Registers
2286 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2287
2288 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2289 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2290 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2291 stack.
2292
2293 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2294 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2295 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2296 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2297 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2298 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2299 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2300
2301 @defmac STACK_REGS
2302 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2303 @end defmac
2304
2305 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2306 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2307 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2308 @end defmac
2309
2310 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2311 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2312 of the stack.
2313 @end defmac
2314
2315 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2316 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2317 the stack.
2318 @end defmac
2319
2320 @node Register Classes
2321 @section Register Classes
2322 @cindex register class definitions
2323 @cindex class definitions, register
2324
2325 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2326 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2327 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2328 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2329
2330 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2331 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2332 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2333
2334 @findex ALL_REGS
2335 @findex NO_REGS
2336 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2337 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2338 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2339 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2340
2341 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2342 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2343 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2344 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2345 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2346 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2347
2348 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2349 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2350
2351 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2352 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2353 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2354 them in operand constraints.
2355
2356 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2357 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2358 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2359 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2360 (@pxref{Costs}).
2361
2362 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2363 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2364 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2365 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2366 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2367 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2368 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2369
2370 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2371 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2372 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2373 in their union.
2374
2375 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2376 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2377 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2378 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2379 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2380
2381 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2382 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2383 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2384 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2385 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2386 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2387 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2388 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2389 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2390
2391 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2392 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2393 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2394 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2395 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2396 tells how many classes there are.
2397
2398 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2399 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2400 in many of the tables described below.
2401 @end deftp
2402
2403 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2404 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2405
2406 @smallexample
2407 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2408 @end smallexample
2409 @end defmac
2410
2411 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2412 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2413 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2414 @end defmac
2415
2416 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2417 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2418 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2419 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2420 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2421
2422 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2423 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2424 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2425 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2426 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2427 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2428 so on.
2429 @end defmac
2430
2431 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2432 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2433 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2434 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2435 register.
2436 @end defmac
2437
2438 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2439 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2440 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2441 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2442 @end defmac
2443
2444 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2445 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2446 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2447 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2448 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2449 @end defmac
2450
2451 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2452 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2453 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2454 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2455 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2456 @end defmac
2457
2458 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2459 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2460 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2461 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2462 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2463 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2464 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2465 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2466 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2467 @end defmac
2468
2469 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2470 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2471 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2472 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2473 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2474 @end defmac
2475
2476 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2477 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2478 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2479 @end defmac
2480
2481 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2482 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2483 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2484 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2485 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2486 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2487 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2488 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2489 @code{address_operand}.
2490 @end defmac
2491
2492 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2493 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2494 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2495 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2496 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2497 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2498 than other base register uses.
2499
2500 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2501 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2502 @end defmac
2503
2504 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2505 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2506 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2507 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2508 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2509 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2510 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2511 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2512 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2513 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2514 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2515 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2516 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2517 @end defmac
2518
2519 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2520 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2521 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2522 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2523 allocated such a hard register.
2524
2525 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2526 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2527 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2528 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2529 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2530 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2531 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2532 only if neither labeling works.
2533 @end defmac
2534
2535 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2536 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2537 @end deftypefn
2538
2539 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2540 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2541 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2542 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2543 another, smaller class.
2544
2545 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2546
2547 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2548 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2549 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2550 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2551 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2552
2553 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2554 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2555 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2556 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2557 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2558 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2559 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2560 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2561 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2562 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2563 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2564
2565 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2566 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2567 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2568 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2569 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2570 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2571 @end deftypefn
2572
2573 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2574 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2575 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2576 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2577 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2578 safe:
2579
2580 @smallexample
2581 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2582 @end smallexample
2583
2584 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2585 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2586 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2587 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2588 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2589
2590 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2591 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2592 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2593 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2594 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2595 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2596 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2597 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2598 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2599 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2600 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2601
2602 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2603 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2604 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2605 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2606 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2607 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2608 @end defmac
2609
2610 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2611 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2612 input reloads.
2613
2614 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2615 argument.
2616
2617 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2618 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2619 @end deftypefn
2620
2621 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2622 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2623 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2624 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2625 ordinarily be used.
2626
2627 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2628 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2629
2630 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2631 smaller class.
2632
2633 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2634 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2635 @end defmac
2636
2637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2638 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2639 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2640 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2641 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2642 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2643 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2644 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2645 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2646 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2647 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2648 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2649 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2650
2651 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2652 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2653 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2654 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2655 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2656 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2657 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2658 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2659 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2660 of the scratch register(s).
2661
2662 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2663
2664 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2665 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2666 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2667 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2668 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2669
2670 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2671 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2672 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2673 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2674 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2675 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2676
2677 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2678 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2679 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2680 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2681 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2682
2683 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2684 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2685 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2686 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2687 single-register-class
2688 @c [later: or memory]
2689 output constraint.
2690
2691 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2692 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2693 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2694 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2695
2696 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2697 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2698 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2699 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2700 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2701 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2702 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2703 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2704
2705
2706 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2707 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2708 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2709 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2710
2711 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2712 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2713 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2714
2715 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2716 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2717 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2718 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2719 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2720 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2721 @end deftypefn
2722
2723 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2724 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2725 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2726 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2727 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2728
2729 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2730 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2731 reload phase that it may
2732 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2733 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2734 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2735 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2736 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2737 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2738
2739 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2740 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2741 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2742 class required. If the
2743 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2744 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2745 macros identically.
2746
2747 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2748 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2749 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2750 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2751 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2752
2753 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2754 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2755 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2756 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2757 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2758 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2759 register.
2760
2761 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2762 register that
2763 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2764 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2765 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2766 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2767 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2768
2769 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2770 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2771 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2772 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2773
2774 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2775 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2776 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2777 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2778 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2779 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2780 general registers.
2781 @end defmac
2782
2783 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2784 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2785 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2786 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2787 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2788 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2789 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2790
2791 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2792 @end defmac
2793
2794 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2795 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2796 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2797 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2798 defined by this macro.
2799
2800 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2801 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2802 @end defmac
2803
2804 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2805 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2806 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2807 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2808 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2809 same as that of @var{mode}.
2810
2811 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2812 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2813 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2814 registers.
2815
2816 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2817 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2818 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2819 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2820 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2821 details.
2822
2823 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2824 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2825 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2826 @end defmac
2827
2828 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2829 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2830 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2831 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2832
2833 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2834 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2835 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2836 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2837 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2838
2839 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2840 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2841 pressure.
2842 @end deftypefn
2843
2844 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
2845 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2846 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2847
2848 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2849 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2850 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2851 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2852 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2853
2854 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2855 in the reload pass.
2856
2857 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2858 in words.
2859 @end deftypefn
2860
2861 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2862 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2863 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2864
2865 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2866 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2867 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2868 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2869
2870 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2871 in the reload pass.
2872 @end defmac
2873
2874 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2875 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2876 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2877
2878 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2879 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2880 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2881 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2882 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2883 as below:
2884
2885 @smallexample
2886 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2887 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2888 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2889 @end smallexample
2890 @end defmac
2891
2892 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2893 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2894 @end deftypefn
2895
2896 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2897 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2898 @end deftypefn
2899
2900 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2901 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2902 @end deftypefn
2903
2904 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, enum @var{machine_mode})
2905 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2906 @end deftypefn
2907
2908 @node Old Constraints
2909 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2910 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2911 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2912
2913 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2914 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2915 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2916 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2917
2918 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2919 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2920 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2921 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2922 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2923 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2924 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2925 to handle specially.
2926 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2927 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2928 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2929 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2930 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2931 @end defmac
2932
2933 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2934 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2935 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2936 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2937 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2938 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2939 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2940 @end defmac
2941
2942 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2943 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2944 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2945 different variants.
2946 @end defmac
2947
2948 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2949 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2950 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2951 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2952 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2953 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2954 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2955 @var{value}.
2956 @end defmac
2957
2958 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2959 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2960 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2961 between different variants.
2962 @end defmac
2963
2964 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2965 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2966 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2967 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2968
2969 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2970 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2971 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2972 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2973
2974 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2975 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2976 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2977 between these kinds.
2978 @end defmac
2979
2980 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2981 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2982 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2983 between different variants.
2984 @end defmac
2985
2986 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2987 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2988 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2989 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2990 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2991 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2992 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2993
2994 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2995 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2996 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2997 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2998
2999 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3000 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3001 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
3002 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3003 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3004 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3005 does not include r0 on the output.
3006 @end defmac
3007
3008 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3009 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3010 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3011 variants.
3012 @end defmac
3013
3014 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3015 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3016 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3017 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3018
3019 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3020 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3021 comprises a subset of all memory references including
3022 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3023 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3024 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3025
3026 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3027 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3028 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3029 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3030 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3031 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3032 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3033 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3034 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3035 @end defmac
3036
3037 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3038 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3039 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3040 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3041 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3042
3043 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3044 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3045 a subset of all memory addresses including
3046 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3047 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3048 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3049
3050 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3051 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3052 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3053 @end defmac
3054
3055 @node Stack and Calling
3056 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3057 @cindex calling conventions
3058
3059 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3060 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3061
3062 @menu
3063 * Frame Layout::
3064 * Exception Handling::
3065 * Stack Checking::
3066 * Frame Registers::
3067 * Elimination::
3068 * Stack Arguments::
3069 * Register Arguments::
3070 * Scalar Return::
3071 * Aggregate Return::
3072 * Caller Saves::
3073 * Function Entry::
3074 * Profiling::
3075 * Tail Calls::
3076 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3077 @end menu
3078
3079 @node Frame Layout
3080 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3081 @cindex stack frame layout
3082 @cindex frame layout
3083
3084 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3085 Here is the basic stack layout.
3086
3087 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3088 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3089 pointer to a smaller address.
3090
3091 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3092 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3093 definition used does not matter.
3094 @end defmac
3095
3096 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3097 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3098 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3099 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3100
3101 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3102 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3103 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3104 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3105 space for the next item on the stack.
3106
3107 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3108 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3109 which is often wrong.
3110 @end defmac
3111
3112 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3113 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3114 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3115 @end defmac
3116
3117 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3118 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3119 addresses on the stack.
3120 @end defmac
3121
3122 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3123 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3124
3125 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3126 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3127 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3128 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3129 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3130 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3131 @end defmac
3132
3133 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3134 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3135 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3136
3137 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3138 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3139 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3140 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3141 @end defmac
3142
3143 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3144 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3145 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3146 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3147
3148 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3149 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3150 @end defmac
3151
3152 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3153 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3154 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3155 function.
3156
3157 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3158 the first argument's address.
3159 @end defmac
3160
3161 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3162 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3163 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3164
3165 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3166 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3167 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3168 @end defmac
3169
3170 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3171 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3172 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3173 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3174 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3175 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3176 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3177 @end defmac
3178
3179 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3180 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3181 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3182 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3183 itself.
3184
3185 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3186 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3187 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3188 @end defmac
3189
3190 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3191 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3192 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3193 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3194 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3195 define this macro.
3196 @end defmac
3197
3198 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3199 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3200 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3201 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3202 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3203 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3204 @end deftypefn
3205
3206 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3207 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3208 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3209 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3210 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3211 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3212 @end defmac
3213
3214 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3215 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3216 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3217 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3218 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3219 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3220
3221 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3222 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3223 determine the return address of other frames.
3224 @end defmac
3225
3226 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3227 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3228 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3229 @end defmac
3230
3231 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3232 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3233 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3234 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3235 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3236 the stack.
3237
3238 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3239 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3240
3241 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3242 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3243 @end defmac
3244
3245 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3246 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3247 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3248 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3249 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3250
3251 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3252 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3253 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3254 over time.
3255 @end defmac
3256
3257 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3258 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3259 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3260 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3261 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3262 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3263 @end defmac
3264
3265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3266 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3267 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3268 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3269 @smallexample
3270 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3271 @end smallexample
3272 and
3273 @smallexample
3274 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3275 @end smallexample
3276 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3277 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3278 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3279 @end deftypefn
3280
3281 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3282 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3283 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3284 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3285 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3286 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3287
3288 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3289 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3290 @end defmac
3291
3292 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3293 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3294 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3295 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3296 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3297 during virtual register instantiation.
3298
3299 The default value for this macro is
3300 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3301 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3302 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3303 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3304 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3305
3306 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3307 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3308 DWARF 2.
3309 @end defmac
3310
3311 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3312 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3313 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3314 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3315 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3316
3317 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3318 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3319 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3320 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3321 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3322 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3323 should be defined.
3324 @end defmac
3325
3326 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3327 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3328 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3329 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3330 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3331 @end defmac
3332
3333 @node Exception Handling
3334 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3335 @cindex exception handling
3336
3337 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3338 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3339 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3340 @var{N} registers are usable.
3341
3342 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3343 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3344 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3345 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3346 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3347
3348 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3349 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3350 @end defmac
3351
3352 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3353 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3354 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3355 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3356 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3357
3358 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3359 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3360
3361 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3362 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3363 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3364 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3365 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3366 that provided by DWARF 2.
3367 @end defmac
3368
3369 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3370 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3371 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3372 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3373
3374 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3375 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3376 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3377 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3378 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3379 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3380 target call frame.
3381
3382 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3383 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3384 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3385
3386 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3387 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3388 @end defmac
3389
3390 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3391 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3392 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3393 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3394 using it to return to the exception handler.
3395 @end defmac
3396
3397 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3398 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3399 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3400 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3401 and so may be read-only.
3402
3403 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3404 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3405 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3406 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3407
3408 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3409 represented directly.
3410 @end defmac
3411
3412 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3413 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3414 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3415 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3416 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3417
3418 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3419 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3420 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3421 to be emitted.
3422 @end defmac
3423
3424 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3425 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3426 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3427 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3428 through signal frames.
3429
3430 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3431 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3432 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3433 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3434 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3435 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3436 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3437 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3438 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3439
3440 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3441 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3442 @end defmac
3443
3444 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3445 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3446 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3447 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3448
3449 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3450 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3451 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3452 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3453 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3454 be updated in @var{fs}.
3455 @end defmac
3456
3457 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3458 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3459 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3460 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3461 @end defmac
3462
3463 @node Stack Checking
3464 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3465
3466 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3467 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3468 three ways:
3469
3470 @enumerate
3471 @item
3472 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3473 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3474 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3475 other special processing.
3476
3477 @item
3478 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3479 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3480 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3481 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3482 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3483 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3484 approach below.
3485
3486 @item
3487 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3488 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3489 @end enumerate
3490
3491 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3492 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3493 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3494 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3495
3496 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3497 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3498 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3499 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3500 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3501 value of this macro is zero.
3502 @end defmac
3503
3504 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3505 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3506 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3507 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3508 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3509 @end defmac
3510
3511 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3512 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3513 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3514 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3515 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3516 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3517 @end defmac
3518
3519 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3520 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3521 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3522 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3523 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3524 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3525 default value of this macro is zero.
3526 @end defmac
3527
3528 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3529 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3530 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3531 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3532 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3533 most machines.
3534 @end defmac
3535
3536 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3537 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3538 in the opposite case.
3539
3540 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3541 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3542 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3543 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3544 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3545 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3546 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3547 @end defmac
3548
3549 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3550 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3551 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3552 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3553 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3554 use the default of four words.
3555 @end defmac
3556
3557 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3558 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3559 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3560 @option{-fstack-check}.
3561 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3562 normally not need to override that default.
3563 @end defmac
3564
3565 @need 2000
3566 @node Frame Registers
3567 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3568
3569 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3570 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3571
3572 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3573 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3574 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3575 the hardware determines which register this is.
3576 @end defmac
3577
3578 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3579 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3580 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3581 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3582 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3583 @end defmac
3584
3585 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3586 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3587 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3588 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3589 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3590 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3591 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3592 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3593 used for the frame pointer.
3594
3595 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3596 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3597 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3598 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3599 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3600 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3601 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3602
3603 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3604 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3605 @end defmac
3606
3607 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3608 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3609 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3610 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3611 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3612 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3613 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3614 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3615 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3616 @end defmac
3617
3618 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3619 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3620 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3621 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3622 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3623 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3624 @end defmac
3625
3626 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3627 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3628 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3629 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3630 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3631 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3632 @end defmac
3633
3634 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3635 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3636 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3637 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3638 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3639 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3640 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3641
3642 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3643 address from the stack.
3644 @end defmac
3645
3646 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3647 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3648 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3649 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3650 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3651 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3652 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3653 not be defined.
3654
3655 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3656
3657 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3658 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3659 @end defmac
3660
3661 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3662 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3663 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3664 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3665 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3666 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3667
3668 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3669
3670 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3671 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3672 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3673 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3674 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3675 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3676 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3677 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3678 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3679 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3680 to refer to those items.
3681 @end deftypefn
3682
3683 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3684 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3685 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3686 DWARF2 exception handling.
3687
3688 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3689 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3690 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3691 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3692 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3693 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3694 registers that are not call-saved.
3695
3696 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3697 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3698 @end defmac
3699
3700 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3701
3702 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3703 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3704
3705 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3706 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3707 @end defmac
3708
3709 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3710
3711 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3712 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3713 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3714 column number to use instead.
3715
3716 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3717 @end defmac
3718
3719 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3720
3721 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3722 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3723 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3724 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3725 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3726
3727 @end defmac
3728
3729 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3730
3731 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3732 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3733 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3734 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3735 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3736
3737 @end defmac
3738
3739 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3740
3741 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3742 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3743 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3744 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3745
3746 @end defmac
3747
3748 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3749
3750 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3751 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3752 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3753 defined and 0 otherwise.
3754
3755 @end defmac
3756
3757 @node Elimination
3758 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3759
3760 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3761 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3762
3763 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3764 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3765 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3766 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3767
3768 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3769 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3770 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3771 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3772 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3773 pointer.
3774
3775 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3776 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3777 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3778 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3779 them.
3780
3781 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3782 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3783 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3784
3785 Default return value is @code{false}.
3786 @end deftypefn
3787
3788 @findex get_frame_size
3789 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3790 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3791 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3792 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3793 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3794 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3795
3796 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3797 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3798 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3799 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3800 @end defmac
3801
3802 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3803 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3804 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3805 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3806 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3807
3808 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3809 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3810
3811 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3812 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3813 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3814 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3815 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3816
3817 In this case, you might specify:
3818 @smallexample
3819 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3820 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3821 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3822 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3823 @end smallexample
3824
3825 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3826 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3827 @end defmac
3828
3829 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3830 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3831 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3832 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3833 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3834 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3835 knows about.
3836
3837 Default return value is @code{true}.
3838 @end deftypefn
3839
3840 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3841 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3842 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3843 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3844 defined.
3845 @end defmac
3846
3847 @node Stack Arguments
3848 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3849 @cindex arguments on stack
3850 @cindex stack arguments
3851
3852 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3853 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3854 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3855
3856 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3857 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3858 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3859 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3860 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3861 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3862 @end deftypefn
3863
3864 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3865 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3866 outgoing arguments.
3867 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3868 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3869 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3870 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3871 @end defmac
3872
3873 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3874 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3875 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3876 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3877 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3878 @end defmac
3879
3880 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3881 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3882 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3883
3884 On some machines, the definition
3885
3886 @smallexample
3887 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3888 @end smallexample
3889
3890 @noindent
3891 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3892 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3893 alignment. Then the definition should be
3894
3895 @smallexample
3896 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3897 @end smallexample
3898
3899 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3900 @end defmac
3901
3902 @findex outgoing_args_size
3903 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3904 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3905 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3906 will be computed and placed into
3907 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3908 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3909 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3910
3911 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3912 is not proper.
3913 @end defmac
3914
3915 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3916 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3917 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3918 registers.
3919
3920 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3921 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3922 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3923 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3924 of the function.
3925
3926 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3927 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3928 which.
3929 @end defmac
3930 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3931 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3932
3933 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3934 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3935 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3936 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3937 if the function called is a library function.
3938
3939 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3940 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3941 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3942 @end defmac
3943
3944 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3945 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3946 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3947 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3948 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3949
3950 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3951 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3952 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3953 stack in its natural location.
3954 @end defmac
3955
3956 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3957 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3958 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3959 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3960
3961 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3962 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3963 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3964 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3965
3966 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3967 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3968 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3969 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3970 arguments (if known).
3971
3972 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3973 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3974 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3975 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3976 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3977 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3978
3979 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3980 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3981 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3982
3983 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3984 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3985 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3986 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3987 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3988 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3989 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3990 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3991 number of arguments.
3992 @end deftypefn
3993
3994 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3995 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3996 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3997 when compiling a function call.
3998
3999 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
4000 have been accumulated.
4001
4002 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
4003 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
4004 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
4005 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
4006 appropriate.
4007 @end defmac
4008
4009 @node Register Arguments
4010 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
4011 @cindex arguments in registers
4012 @cindex registers arguments
4013
4014 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4015 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4016 the stack.
4017
4018 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4019 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
4020 register and if so, which register.
4021
4022 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
4023 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4024 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4025 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4026 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
4027 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
4028 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
4029 syntax error has previously occurred.
4030
4031 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4032 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
4033 on the stack.
4034
4035 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4036 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4037 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4038 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4039 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4040 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4041 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4042 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4043 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4044 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4045 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4046 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4047 argument is also stored on the stack.
4048
4049 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4050 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4051 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4052
4053 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4054 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4055 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4056 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4057 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4058 @var{named} is @code{false}.
4059
4060 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4061 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4062 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4063 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4064 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4065 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4066 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4067 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4068 a register.
4069 @end deftypefn
4070
4071 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4072 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4073 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4074 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4075 documentation.
4076 @end deftypefn
4077
4078 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4079 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4080 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4081 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4082 argument.
4083
4084 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4085 which the caller passes the value, and
4086 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4087 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4088 arrive.
4089
4090 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4091 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4092 @end deftypefn
4093
4094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4095 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4096 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4097 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4098 pushed on the stack.
4099
4100 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4101 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4102 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4103 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4104 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4105 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4106 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4107
4108 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4109 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4110 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4111 @end deftypefn
4112
4113 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4114 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4115 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4116 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4117 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4118
4119 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4120 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4121 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4122 to that type.
4123 @end deftypefn
4124
4125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4126 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4127 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4128 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4129 by the caller.
4130
4131 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4132 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4133 not be generated.
4134
4135 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4136 @end deftypefn
4137
4138 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4139 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4140 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4141 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4142 of bytes of argument so far.
4143
4144 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4145 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4146 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4147 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4148 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4149 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4150 @end defmac
4151
4152 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4153 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4154 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4155 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4156 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4157 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4158 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4159 @end defmac
4160
4161 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4162 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4163 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4164 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4165 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4166 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4167 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4168 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4169 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4170 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4171 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4172 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4173 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4174
4175 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4176 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4177 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4178 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4179 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4180 never both of them at once.
4181 @end defmac
4182
4183 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4184 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4185 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4186 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4187 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4188 0)} is used instead.
4189 @end defmac
4190
4191 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4192 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4193 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4194 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4195
4196 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4197 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4198 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4199 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4200 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4201 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4202 @end defmac
4203
4204 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4205 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4206 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4207 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4208 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4209 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4210
4211 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4212 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4213 used for arguments without any special help.
4214 @end deftypefn
4215
4216 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4217 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4218 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4219 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4220 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4221 top.
4222 @end defmac
4223
4224 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4225 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4226 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4227 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4228 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4229
4230 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4231 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4232 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4233
4234 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4235 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4236 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4237 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4238 @end defmac
4239
4240 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4241 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4242 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4243 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4244 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4245 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4246 @end defmac
4247
4248 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4249 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4250 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4251 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4252 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4253 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4254 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4255 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4256 required.
4257 @end defmac
4258
4259 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4260 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4261 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4262 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4263 @end deftypefn
4264
4265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4266 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4267 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4268 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4269 value.
4270 @end deftypefn
4271
4272 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4273 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4274 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4275 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4276 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4277 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4278 stack.
4279 @end defmac
4280
4281 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4282 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4283 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4284 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4285 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4286 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4287 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4288 point register.
4289
4290 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4291 false.
4292 @end deftypefn
4293
4294 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4295 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4296 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4297 @end deftypefn
4298
4299 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4300 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4301 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4302 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4303 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4304 variable.
4305 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4306 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4307 internal type.
4308 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4309 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4310 macro to iterate through all types.
4311 @end deftypefn
4312
4313 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4314 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4315 @var{fndecl}.
4316 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4317 @end deftypefn
4318
4319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4320 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4321 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4322 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4323 @end deftypefn
4324
4325 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4326 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4327 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4328 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4329 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4330 @end deftypefn
4331
4332 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4333 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4334 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4335 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4336 @end deftypefn
4337
4338 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref_s *@var{ref})
4339 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4340 @end deftypefn
4341
4342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4343 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4344 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4345 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4346 must work.
4347
4348 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4349 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4350 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4351 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4352 @end deftypefn
4353
4354 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4355 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4356 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4357 must have move patterns for this mode.
4358 @end deftypefn
4359
4360 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4361 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4362 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4363 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4364 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4365
4366 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4367 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4368 has operations like:
4369
4370 @smallexample
4371 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4372 @end smallexample
4373
4374 where the return type is defined as:
4375
4376 @smallexample
4377 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4378 @{
4379 int8x8_t val[3];
4380 @} int8x8x3_t;
4381 @end smallexample
4382
4383 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4384 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4385 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4386 @end deftypefn
4387
4388 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4389 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4390 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4391 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4392 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4393 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4394 for any mode.
4395
4396 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4397 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4398 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4399 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4400 insn.
4401
4402 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4403 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4404 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4405 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4406 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4407 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4408 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4409 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4410 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4411
4412 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4413 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4414 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4415 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4416 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4417 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4418 @end deftypefn
4419
4420 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4421 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4422 @end deftypevr
4423
4424 @node Scalar Return
4425 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4426 @cindex return values in registers
4427 @cindex values, returned by functions
4428 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4429
4430 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4431 values---values that can fit in registers.
4432
4433 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4434
4435 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4436 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4437 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4438 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4439 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4440 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4441 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4442 a function returns a value.
4443
4444 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4445 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4446 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4447 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4448 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4449 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4450 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4451 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4452 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4453 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4454 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4455 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4456
4457 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4458 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4459 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4460
4461 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4462 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4463 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4464 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4465 known.
4466
4467 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4468 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4469 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4470 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4471
4472 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4473 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4474 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4475 @end deftypefn
4476
4477 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4478 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4479 a new target instead.
4480 @end defmac
4481
4482 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4483 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4484 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4485
4486 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4487 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4488 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4489 compiled.
4490 @end defmac
4491
4492 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4493 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4494 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4495
4496 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4497 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4498 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4499
4500 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4501 @end deftypefn
4502
4503 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4504 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4505 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4506
4507 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4508 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4509 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4510 suffices:
4511
4512 @smallexample
4513 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4514 @end smallexample
4515
4516 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4517 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4518 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4519
4520 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4521 for a new target instead.
4522 @end defmac
4523
4524 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4525 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4526 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4527
4528 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4529 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4530 recognized by this target hook.
4531
4532 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4533 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4534 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4535
4536 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4537 @end deftypefn
4538
4539 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4540 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4541 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4542 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4543 @end defmac
4544
4545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4546 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4547 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4548 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4549 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4550
4551 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4552 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4553 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4554 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4555 @code{SImode} rtx.
4556 @end deftypefn
4557
4558 @node Aggregate Return
4559 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4560 @cindex aggregates as return values
4561 @cindex large return values
4562 @cindex returning aggregate values
4563 @cindex structure value address
4564
4565 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4566 cases), the value is not returned according to
4567 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4568 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4569 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4570 address}.
4571
4572 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4573 memory.
4574
4575 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4576 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4577 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4578 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4579 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4580 libcalls.
4581
4582 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4583 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4584 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4585 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4586 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4587 values, and 0 otherwise.
4588
4589 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4590 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4591 to indicate this.
4592 @end deftypefn
4593
4594 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4595 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4596 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4597 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4598 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4599 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4600 target hook.
4601
4602 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4603 @end defmac
4604
4605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4606 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4607 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4608 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4609 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4610 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4611 argument.
4612
4613 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4614 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4615 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4616 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4617 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4618 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4619 the caller.
4620
4621 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4622 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4623 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4624 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4625 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4626 @end deftypefn
4627
4628 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4629 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4630 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4631 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4632
4633 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4634 pass an address to the subroutine.
4635
4636 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4637 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4638 @end defmac
4639
4640 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4641 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4642 @end deftypefn
4643
4644 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4645 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4646 @end deftypefn
4647
4648 @node Caller Saves
4649 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4650
4651 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4652 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4653 must live across calls.
4654
4655 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4656 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4657 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4658 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4659 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4660
4661 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4662 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4663 @end defmac
4664
4665 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4666 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4667 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4668 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4669 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4670 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4671 @end defmac
4672
4673 @node Function Entry
4674 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4675 @cindex function entry and exit
4676 @cindex prologue
4677 @cindex epilogue
4678
4679 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4680 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4681
4682 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4683 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4684 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4685 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4686 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4687 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4688 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4689
4690 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4691 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4692
4693 @findex regs_ever_live
4694 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4695 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4696 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4697 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4698 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4699 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4700
4701 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4702 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4703 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4704 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4705 registers are used in the function.
4706
4707 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4708 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4709 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4710 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4711 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4712 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4713 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4714
4715 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4716 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4717 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4718 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4719 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4720 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4721 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4722 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4723 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4724 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4725 @end deftypefn
4726
4727 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4728 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4729 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4730 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4731 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4732 @end deftypefn
4733
4734 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4735 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4736 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4737 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4738 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4739 @end deftypefn
4740
4741 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4742 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4743 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4744 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4745 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4746 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4747 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4748 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4749
4750 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4751 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4752 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4753 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4754
4755 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4756 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4757 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4758 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4759 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4760 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4761
4762 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4763 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4764 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4765 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4766 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4767 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4768
4769 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4770 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4771 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4772 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4773
4774 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4775 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4776 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4777 number of arguments.
4778
4779 @findex pops_args
4780 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4781 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4782 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4783 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4784 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4785 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4786 @end deftypefn
4787
4788 @itemize @bullet
4789 @item
4790 @findex pretend_args_size
4791 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4792 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4793 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4794 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4795 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4796 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4797 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4798 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4799 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4800 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4801
4802 @item
4803 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4804 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4805 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4806 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4807 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4808 a save area.
4809
4810 @item
4811 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4812 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4813 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4814 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4815
4816 @item
4817 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4818 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4819 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4820 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4821 @end itemize
4822
4823 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4824 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4825 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4826 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4827 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4828 default is 0.
4829
4830 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4831 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4832 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4833 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4834 @end defmac
4835
4836 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4837 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4838 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4839 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4840 @end defmac
4841
4842 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4843 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4844 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4845 on entry to an exception edge.
4846 @end defmac
4847
4848 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4849 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4850 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4851 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4852 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4853 the real function.
4854
4855 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4856 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4857 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4858 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4859 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4860 all other incoming arguments.
4861
4862 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4863 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4864 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4865
4866 @smallexample
4867 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4868 @end smallexample
4869
4870 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4871 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4872 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4873 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4874
4875 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4876 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4877 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4878 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4879
4880 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4881 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4882 some targets, but probably not.
4883
4884 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4885 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4886 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4887 not support varargs.
4888 @end deftypefn
4889
4890 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4891 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4892 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4893 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4894 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4895 previously exposed.
4896 @end deftypefn
4897
4898 @node Profiling
4899 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4900 @cindex profiling, code generation
4901
4902 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4903
4904 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4905 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4906 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4907
4908 @findex mcount
4909 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4910 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4911 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4912 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4913
4914 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4915 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4916 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4917 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4918 @end defmac
4919
4920 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4921 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4922 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4923 not support profiling.
4924 @end defmac
4925
4926 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4927 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4928 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4929 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4930 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4931 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4932 @end defmac
4933
4934 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4935 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4936 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4937 @end defmac
4938
4939 @node Tail Calls
4940 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4941 @cindex tail calls
4942
4943 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4944 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4945 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4946 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4947
4948 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4949 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4950 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4951 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4952 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4953 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4954 @end deftypefn
4955
4956 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4957 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4958 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4959 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4960 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4961 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4962 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4963 @end deftypefn
4964
4965 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4966 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4967 @end deftypefn
4968
4969 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4970 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4971 @end deftypefn
4972
4973 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4974 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4975 @cindex stack smashing protection
4976
4977 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4978 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4979 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4980 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4981 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4982 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4983
4984 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4985 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4986 @end deftypefn
4987
4988 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4989 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
4990 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4991 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4992
4993 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4994 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4995 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4996 @end deftypefn
4997
4998 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
4999 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5000 @end deftypefn
5001
5002 @node Varargs
5003 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5004 @cindex varargs implementation
5005
5006 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5007 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5008 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5009 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5010 conditionals to include it.
5011
5012 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5013 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5014 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5015 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5016 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5017 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5018
5019 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5020 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5021 below.
5022
5023 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5024 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5025 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5026 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5027 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5028
5029 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5030 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5031 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5032 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5033
5034 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5035 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5036 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5037 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5038 to use them for its own purposes.
5039 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5040 @c 10feb93
5041 @end defmac
5042
5043 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5044 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5045 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5046 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5047 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5048 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5049 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5050 of the current function.
5051 @end defmac
5052
5053 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5054 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5055 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5056 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5057 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5058 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5059
5060 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5061 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5062 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5063
5064 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5065 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5066 @end defmac
5067
5068 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5069
5070 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5071 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5072 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5073 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5074 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5075 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5076 @end deftypefn
5077
5078 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5079 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5080 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5081 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5082 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5083 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5084 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5085 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5086
5087 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5088 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5089 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5090 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5091
5092 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5093 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5094 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5095 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5096 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5097 frame.
5098
5099 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5100 compile time without knowing their data types,
5101 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5102 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5103 for all data types.
5104
5105 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5106 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5107 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5108 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5109 not generate any instructions in this case.
5110 @end deftypefn
5111
5112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5113 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5114 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5115
5116 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5117 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5118 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5119 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5120 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5121 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5122 except the last are treated as named.
5123
5124 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5125 @end deftypefn
5126
5127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5128 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5129 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5130 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5131 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5132 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5133 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5134 @end deftypefn
5135
5136 @node Trampolines
5137 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5138 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5139 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5140
5141 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5142 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5143 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5144 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5145 trampoline.
5146
5147 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5148 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5149 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5150 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5151 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5152 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5153 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5154 operands.
5155
5156 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5157 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5158 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5159 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5160 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5161 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5162 separately.
5163
5164 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5165 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5166 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5167 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5168 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5169
5170 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5171 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5172 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5173 to generate it on the spot.
5174 @end deftypefn
5175
5176 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5177 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5178 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5179 @end defmac
5180
5181 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5182 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5183 @end defmac
5184
5185 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5186 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5187
5188 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5189 is used for aligning trampolines.
5190 @end defmac
5191
5192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5193 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5194 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5195 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5196 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5197 when it is called.
5198
5199 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5200 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5201 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5202 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5203 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5204 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5205
5206 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5207 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5208 initializing the trampoline proper.
5209 @end deftypefn
5210
5211 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5212 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5213 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5214 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5215 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5216 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5217 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5218 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5219 @end deftypefn
5220
5221 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5222 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5223 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5224 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5225
5226 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5227 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5228 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5229 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5230 latter makes initialization faster.
5231
5232 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5233 the following macro.
5234
5235 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5236 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5237 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5238 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5239 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5240 @end defmac
5241
5242 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5243 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5244 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5245 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5246 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5247
5248 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5249 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5250 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5251 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5252 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5253
5254 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5255 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5256 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5257 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5258 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5259 special assembler code.
5260 @end defmac
5261
5262 @node Library Calls
5263 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5264 @cindex library subroutine names
5265 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5266
5267 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5268 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5269
5270 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5271 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5272 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5273 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5274 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5275 @end defmac
5276
5277 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5278 @findex init_one_libfunc
5279 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5280 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5281 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5282 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5283 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5284 library routines.
5285
5286 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5287 @end deftypefn
5288
5289 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5290 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5291 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5292 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5293 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5294 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5295 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5296 @end deftypevr
5297
5298 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5299 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5300 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5301 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5302 return a tristate.
5303
5304 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5305 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5306 don't need to define this macro.
5307 @end defmac
5308
5309 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5310 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5311 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5312 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5313 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5314 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5315 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5316 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5317 @end defmac
5318
5319 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5320 @findex matherr
5321 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5322 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5323 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5324 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5325 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5326 system.
5327
5328 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5329 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5330 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5331 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5332 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5333 @end defmac
5334
5335 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5336 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5337 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5338 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5339 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5340 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5341 @end defmac
5342
5343 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5344 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5345 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5346 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5347 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5348 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5349 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5350 @end defmac
5351
5352 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5353 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5354 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5355 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5356 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5357 @smallexample
5358 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5359 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5360 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5361 @end smallexample
5362 @end defmac
5363
5364 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5365 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5366 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5367 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5368 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5369 the NeXT runtime installed.
5370
5371 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5372 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5373 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5374
5375 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5376 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5377 @end defmac
5378
5379 @node Addressing Modes
5380 @section Addressing Modes
5381 @cindex addressing modes
5382
5383 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5384 This is about addressing modes.
5385
5386 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5387 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5388 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5389 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5390 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5391 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5392 @end defmac
5393
5394 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5395 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5396 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5397 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5398 the size of the memory operand.
5399 @end defmac
5400
5401 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5402 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5403 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5404 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5405 @end defmac
5406
5407 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5408 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5409 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5410 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5411 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5412 constant addresses are supported.
5413 @end defmac
5414
5415 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5416 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5417 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5418 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5419 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5420 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5421 @end defmac
5422
5423 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5424 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5425 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5426 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5427 accept.
5428 @end defmac
5429
5430 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5431 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5432 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5433
5434 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5435 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5436 desired by the caller.
5437
5438 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5439 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5440 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5441 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5442 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5443 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5444 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5445 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5446
5447 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5448 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5449 register is required.
5450
5451 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5452 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5453 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5454 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5455 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5456
5457 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5458 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5459 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5460 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5461 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5462
5463 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5464 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5465 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5466 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5467 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5468 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5469 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5470 Format}.
5471
5472 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5473 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5474 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5475 has this syntax:
5476
5477 @example
5478 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5479 @end example
5480
5481 @noindent
5482 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5483 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5484
5485 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5486 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5487 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5488 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5489 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5490
5491 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5492 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5493 @end deftypefn
5494
5495 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5496 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5497 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5498 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5499 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5500 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5501 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5502 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5503 @code{'m'} constraint.
5504 @end defmac
5505
5506 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5507 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5508 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5509 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5510 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5511
5512 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5513 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5514
5515 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5516 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5517 @end defmac
5518
5519 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5520 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5521 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5522 address.
5523
5524 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5525 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5526 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5527 @var{x}.
5528
5529 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5530 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5531 should return the new @var{x}.
5532
5533 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5534 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5535 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5536 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5537 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5538 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5539 strategy can generate better code.
5540 @end deftypefn
5541
5542 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5543 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5544 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5545 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5546 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5547 performance reasons.
5548
5549 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5550 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5551 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5552 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5553 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5554 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5555 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5556 be shared.
5557
5558 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5559 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5560 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5561 of reload internals.
5562
5563 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5564 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5565 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5566
5567 @findex push_reload
5568 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5569 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5570 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5571
5572 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5573 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5574 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5575 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5576 @code{push_reload}.
5577
5578 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5579 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5580 the address has become legitimate.
5581
5582 @findex copy_rtx
5583 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5584 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5585 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5586 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5587 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5588 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5589 @end defmac
5590
5591 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5592 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5593 space @var{addrspace} can have
5594 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5595 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5596 but not others.
5597
5598 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5599 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5600 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5601 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5602
5603 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5604
5605 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5606 @end deftypefn
5607
5608 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5609 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5610 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5611 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5612
5613 The default definition returns true.
5614 @end deftypefn
5615
5616 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5617 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5618 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5619 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5620 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5621 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5622 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5623 into their original form.
5624 @end deftypefn
5625
5626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5627 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5628 debug sections.
5629 @end deftypefn
5630
5631 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5632 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5633 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5634 of @var{x}.
5635
5636 The default version of this hook returns false.
5637
5638 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5639 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5640 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5641 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5642 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5643 @end deftypefn
5644
5645 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5646 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5647 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5648 of @var{x}.
5649
5650 The default version returns false for all constants.
5651 @end deftypefn
5652
5653 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5654 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5655 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5656
5657 The default version returns true for all decls.
5658 @end deftypefn
5659
5660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5661 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5662 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5663 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5664 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5665 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5666 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5667 function are valid.
5668 @end deftypefn
5669
5670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5671 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5672 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5673 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5674 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5675
5676 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5677 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5678 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5679 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5680 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5681 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5682 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5683 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5684 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5685 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5686 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5687
5688 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5689 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5690 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5691 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5692 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5693 described above.
5694 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5695 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5696 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5697 @end deftypefn
5698
5699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5700 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5701 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5702 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5703 @end deftypefn
5704
5705 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5706 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5707 @end deftypefn
5708
5709 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (enum @var{machine_mode}, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5710 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5711 @end deftypefn
5712
5713 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5714 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5715 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5716 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5717 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5718 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5719
5720 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5721 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5722 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5723 @end deftypefn
5724
5725 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5726 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5727 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5728 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5729 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5730 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5731 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5732 @end deftypefn
5733
5734 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5735 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5736 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5737 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5738 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5739 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5740 @end deftypefn
5741
5742 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5743 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5744 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5745 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5746 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5747 @end deftypefn
5748
5749 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5750 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5751 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5752 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5753 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5754 @end deftypefn
5755
5756 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5757 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5758 @end deftypefn
5759
5760 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5761 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5762 @end deftypefn
5763
5764 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5765 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5766 @end deftypefn
5767
5768 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5769 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5770 @end deftypefn
5771
5772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5773 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5774 @end deftypefn
5775
5776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5777 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5778 @end deftypefn
5779
5780 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5781 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5782 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5783 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5784 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5785 loads.
5786 @end deftypefn
5787
5788 @node Anchored Addresses
5789 @section Anchored Addresses
5790 @cindex anchored addresses
5791 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5792
5793 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5794 For example, if we have:
5795
5796 @smallexample
5797 static int a, b, c;
5798 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5799 @end smallexample
5800
5801 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5802 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5803 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5804 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5805 be something like:
5806
5807 @smallexample
5808 int foo (void)
5809 @{
5810 register int *xr = &x;
5811 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5812 @}
5813 @end smallexample
5814
5815 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5816 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5817
5818 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5819 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5820 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5821 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5822
5823 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5824 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5825 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5826 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5827 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5828 @end deftypevr
5829
5830 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5831 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5832 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5833 value is 0.
5834 @end deftypevr
5835
5836 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5837 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5838 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5839 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5840 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5841
5842 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5843 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5844 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5845 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5846 @end deftypefn
5847
5848 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5849 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5850 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5851 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5852
5853 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5854 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5855 or target-specific sections.
5856 @end deftypefn
5857
5858 @node Condition Code
5859 @section Condition Code Status
5860 @cindex condition code status
5861
5862 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5863 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5864
5865 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5866 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5867 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5868 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5869 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5870 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5871 most RISC machines.
5872
5873 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5874 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5875 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5876 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5877 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5878 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5879 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5880 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5881
5882 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5883 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5884 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5885 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5886 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5887 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5888 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5889
5890 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5891 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5892 interested in most macros in this section.
5893
5894 @menu
5895 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5896 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5897 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5898 @end menu
5899
5900 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5901 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5902 @findex cc0
5903
5904 @findex cc_status
5905 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5906 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5907 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5908 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5909 currently based, and several standard flags.
5910
5911 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5912 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5913 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5914
5915 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5916 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5917 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5918
5919 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5920 @end defmac
5921
5922 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5923 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5924 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5925 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5926 define this macro to initialize it.
5927
5928 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5929 @end defmac
5930
5931 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5932 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5933 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5934 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5935 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5936 set @code{(cc0)}.
5937
5938 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5939
5940 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5941 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5942 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5943 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5944 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5945 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5946 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5947 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5948 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5949 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5950 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5951 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5952 condition code value.
5953
5954 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5955 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5956 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5957 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5958 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5959 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5960 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5961
5962 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5963 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5964 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5965 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5966 @end defmac
5967
5968 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5969 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5970 @findex CCmode
5971 @findex MODE_CC
5972
5973 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5974 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5975 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5976 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5977 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5978 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5979 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5980 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5981 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5982 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5983 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5984
5985 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5986 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5987 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5988 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5989 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5990 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5991 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5992
5993 @smallexample
5994 (define_insn ""
5995 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5996 (compare:CC_NOOV
5997 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5998 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5999 (const_int 0)))]
6000 ""
6001 "@dots{}")
6002 @end smallexample
6003
6004 @noindent
6005 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6006 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6007
6008 @smallexample
6009 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6010 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6011 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6012 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6013 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6014 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6015 @end smallexample
6016
6017 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6018 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6019 this section.
6020
6021 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6022 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6023 @end defmac
6024
6025 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value}) (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1}, @var{op0_preserve_value})
6026 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6027 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6028 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6029 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6030
6031 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6032 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6033 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6034 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6035 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6036 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6037 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6038
6039 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6040 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6041 @file{md} file.
6042
6043 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6044 comparison code or operands.
6045 @end deftypefn
6046
6047 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6048 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6049 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6050 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6051 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6052
6053 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6054 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6055 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6056 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6057
6058 @smallexample
6059 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6060 @end smallexample
6061 @end defmac
6062
6063 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6064 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6065 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6066 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6067 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6068 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6069 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6070 like:
6071
6072 @smallexample
6073 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6074 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6075 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6076 @end smallexample
6077 @end defmac
6078
6079 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6080 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6081 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6082 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6083 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6084 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6085 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6086 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6087 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6088 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6089 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6090
6091 The default version of this hook returns false.
6092 @end deftypefn
6093
6094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
6095 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6096 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6097 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6098 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6099 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6100 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6101
6102 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6103 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6104 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6105 @end deftypefn
6106
6107 @node Cond Exec Macros
6108 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6109 @findex conditional execution
6110 @findex predication
6111
6112 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6113 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6114 represent conditional branches.
6115
6116 @node Costs
6117 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6118 @cindex costs of instructions
6119 @cindex relative costs
6120 @cindex speed of instructions
6121
6122 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6123 on the target machine.
6124
6125 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6126 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6127 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6128 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6129 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6130 that.
6131
6132 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6133 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6134 registers if they are not general registers.
6135
6136 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6137 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6138 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6139 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6140 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6141 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6142
6143 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6144 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6145 @end defmac
6146
6147 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6148 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6149 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6150 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6151 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6152 that.
6153
6154 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6155 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6156 registers if they are not general registers.
6157
6158 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6159 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6160 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6161 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6162 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6163 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6164
6165 The default version of this function returns 2.
6166 @end deftypefn
6167
6168 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6169 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6170 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6171 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6172 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6173 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6174 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6175
6176 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6177 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6178 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6179 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6180 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6181 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6182
6183 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6184 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6185 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6186 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6187 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6188 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6189 are the same as to this macro.
6190
6191 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6192 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6193 @end defmac
6194
6195 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6196 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6197 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6198 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6199 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6200 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6201 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6202
6203 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6204 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6205 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6206 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6207 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6208 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6209
6210 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6211 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6212 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6213 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6214 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6215 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6216 are the same as to this target hook.
6217 @end deftypefn
6218
6219 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6220 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6221 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6222 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6223 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6224 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6225 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6226 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6227 @end defmac
6228
6229 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6230 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6231 ordinarily expect.
6232
6233 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6234 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6235 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6236 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6237 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6238 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6239
6240 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6241 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6242 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6243 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6244 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6245 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6246 @end defmac
6247
6248 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6249 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6250 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6251 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6252 handler.
6253
6254 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6255 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6256 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6257 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6258 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6259
6260 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6261 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6262 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6263 @end defmac
6264
6265 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6266 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6267 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6268 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6269 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6270
6271 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6272 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6273 the number of such sequences.
6274
6275 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6276 optimized for speed rather than size.
6277
6278 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6279 @end defmac
6280
6281 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6282 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6283 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6284 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6285 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6286 @end defmac
6287
6288 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6289 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6290 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6291 @end defmac
6292
6293 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6294 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6295 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6296 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6297 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6298
6299 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6300 optimized for speed rather than size.
6301
6302 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6303 @end defmac
6304
6305 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6306 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6307 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6308 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6309 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6310 @end defmac
6311
6312 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6313 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6314 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6315 a block set insn or a library call.
6316 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6317 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6318
6319 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6320 optimized for speed rather than size.
6321
6322 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6323 @end defmac
6324
6325 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6326 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6327 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6328 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6329 storing values other than constant zero.
6330 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6331 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6332 @end defmac
6333
6334 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6335 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6336 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6337 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6338 called with a constant source string.
6339 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6340 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6341 @end defmac
6342
6343 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6344 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6345 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6346 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6347 @end defmac
6348
6349 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6350 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6351 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6352 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6353 @end defmac
6354
6355 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6356 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6357 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6358 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6359 @end defmac
6360
6361 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6362 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6363 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6364 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6365 @end defmac
6366
6367 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6368 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6369 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6370 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6371 @end defmac
6372
6373 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6374 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6375 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6376 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6377 @end defmac
6378
6379 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6380 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6381 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6382 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6383 @end defmac
6384
6385 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6386 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6387 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6388 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6389 @end defmac
6390
6391 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6392 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6393 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6394 @end defmac
6395
6396 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6397 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6398 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6399 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6400 @end defmac
6401
6402 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6403 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6404
6405 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6406 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6407 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6408 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6409 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6410 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6411 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6412
6413 @var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6414 obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6415
6416 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6417 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6418 instructions.
6419
6420 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6421 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6422 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6423 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6424 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6425
6426 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6427 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6428 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6429
6430 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6431 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6432 @end deftypefn
6433
6434 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6435 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6436 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6437 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6438
6439 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6440 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6441 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6442 all addresses will have equal costs.
6443
6444 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6445 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6446 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6447
6448 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6449 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6450 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6451 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6452 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6453 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6454 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6455 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6456
6457 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6458
6459 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6460 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6461 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6462 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6463 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6464 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6465 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6466 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6467 @end deftypefn
6468
6469 @node Scheduling
6470 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6471
6472 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6473 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6474 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6475 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6476
6477 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6478 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6479 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6480 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6481 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6482 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6483 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6484 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6485 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6486 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6487 @end deftypefn
6488
6489 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6490 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6491 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6492 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6493 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6494 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6495 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6496 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6497 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6498 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6499 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6500 was scheduled.
6501 @end deftypefn
6502
6503 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6504 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6505 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6506 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6507 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6508 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6509 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6510 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6511 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6512 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6513 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6514 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6515 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6516 @end deftypefn
6517
6518 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6519 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6520 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6521 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6522 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6523 scheduling priorities of insns.
6524 @end deftypefn
6525
6526 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6527 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6528 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6529 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6530 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6531 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6532 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6533 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6534 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6535 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6536 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6537 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6538 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6539 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6540 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6541 @end deftypefn
6542
6543 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6544 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6545 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6546 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6547 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6548 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6549 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6550 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6551 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6552 @end deftypefn
6553
6554 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6555 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6556 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6557 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6558 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6559 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6560 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6561 calculated.
6562 @end deftypefn
6563
6564 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6565 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6566 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6567 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6568 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6569 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6570 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6571 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6572 @end deftypefn
6573
6574 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6575 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6576 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6577 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6578 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6579 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6580 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6581 @end deftypefn
6582
6583 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6584 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6585 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6586 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6587 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6588 @end deftypefn
6589
6590 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6591 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6592 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6593 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6594 @end deftypefn
6595
6596 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6597 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6598 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6599 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6600 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6601 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6602 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6603 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6604 @end deftypefn
6605
6606 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6607 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6608 @end deftypefn
6609
6610 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6611 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6612 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6613 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6614 @end deftypefn
6615
6616 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6617 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6618 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6619 @end deftypefn
6620
6621 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6622 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6623 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6624 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6625 state on a single insn is not enough.
6626 @end deftypefn
6627
6628 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6629 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6630 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6631 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6632 state on a single insn is not enough.
6633 @end deftypefn
6634
6635 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6636 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6637 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6638 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6639 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6640 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6641 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6642 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6643 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6644 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6645 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6646
6647 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6648 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6649 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6650 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6651 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6652 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6653 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6654 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6655 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6656
6657 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6658 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6659 schedules to choose the best one.
6660
6661 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6662 @end deftypefn
6663
6664 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
6665
6666 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6667 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6668 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6669 be issued.
6670
6671 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6672 @end deftypefn
6673
6674 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6675 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6676 scheduling.
6677 @end deftypefn
6678
6679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6680 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6681 @end deftypefn
6682
6683 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6684 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6685 an instruction.
6686 @end deftypefn
6687
6688 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6689 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6690 round of multipass scheduling.
6691 @end deftypefn
6692
6693 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6694 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6695 @end deftypefn
6696
6697 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6698 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6699 @end deftypefn
6700
6701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6702 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6703 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6704 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6705 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6706 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6707 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6708 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6709 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6710 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6711 and the current processor cycle.
6712 @end deftypefn
6713
6714 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6715 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6716 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6717 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6718 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6719 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6720 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6721 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6722 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6723 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6724 and @code{false} otherwise.
6725
6726 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6727 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6728 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6729 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6730 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6731 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6732 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6733 @end deftypefn
6734
6735 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6736 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6737 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6738 per instruction data structures.
6739 @end deftypefn
6740
6741 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6742 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6743 @end deftypefn
6744
6745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6746 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6747 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6748 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6749 @end deftypefn
6750
6751 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6752 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6753 @end deftypefn
6754
6755 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6756 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6757 @end deftypefn
6758
6759 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6760 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6761 @end deftypefn
6762
6763 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6764 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6765 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6766 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6767 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6768 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6769 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6770 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6771 the generated speculative pattern.
6772 @end deftypefn
6773
6774 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
6775 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6776 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6777 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6778 @end deftypefn
6779
6780 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
6781 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6782 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6783 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6784 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6785 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6786 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6787 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6788 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6789 @end deftypefn
6790
6791 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
6792 This hook is used as a workaround for
6793 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6794 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6795 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6796 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6797 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6798 For non-speculative instructions,
6799 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6800 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6801 is nearly full.
6802 @end deftypefn
6803
6804 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6805 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6806 enabled/used.
6807 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6808 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6809 @end deftypefn
6810
6811 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6812 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6813 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6814 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6815 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6816 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6817 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6818 @end deftypefn
6819
6820 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6821 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6822 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6823 @end deftypefn
6824
6825 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6826 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6827 in its second parameter.
6828 @end deftypefn
6829
6830 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6831 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6832 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6833 also the latencies of operations.
6834 @end deftypevr
6835
6836 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
6837 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6838 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6839 @end deftypefn
6840
6841 @node Sections
6842 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6843 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6844 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6845
6846 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6847 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6848 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6849 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6850 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6851 of sections.
6852
6853 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6854 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6855 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6856 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6857 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6858 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6859 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6860
6861 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6862 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6863 to be string literals.
6864
6865 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6866 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6867 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6868 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6869
6870 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6871 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6872 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6873 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6874 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6875 reuse @code{text_section}.
6876
6877 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6878 if the target does not provide them.
6879
6880 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6881 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6882 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6883 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6884 @end defmac
6885
6886 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6887 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6888 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6889 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6890 @end defmac
6891
6892 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6893 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6894 executed functions in the program.
6895 @end defmac
6896
6897 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6898 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6899 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6900 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6901 @end defmac
6902
6903 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6904 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6905 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6906 initialized, writable small data.
6907 @end defmac
6908
6909 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6910 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6911 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6912 data.
6913 @end defmac
6914
6915 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6916 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6917 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6918 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6919 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6920 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6921 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6922 used.
6923 @end defmac
6924
6925 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6926 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6927 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6928 uninitialized, writable small data.
6929 @end defmac
6930
6931 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6932 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6933 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6934 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6935 @end defmac
6936
6937 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6938 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6939 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6940 default is @code{'T'}.
6941 @end defmac
6942
6943 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6944 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6945 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6946 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6947 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6948 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6949 @end defmac
6950
6951 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6952 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6953 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6954 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6955 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6956 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6957 @end defmac
6958
6959 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6960 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6961 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6962 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6963 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6964 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6965 @end defmac
6966
6967 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6968 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6969 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6970 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6971 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6972 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6973 @end defmac
6974
6975 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6976 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6977 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6978 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6979 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6980 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6981 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6982 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6983 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6984 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6985 @end defmac
6986
6987 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6988 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6989 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6990 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6991 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6992 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6993 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6994 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6995 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6996 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6997 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6998 @end defmac
6999
7000 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7001 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7002 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7003 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7004 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7005 @end defmac
7006
7007 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7008 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7009 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7010 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7011 readonly data section is used.
7012
7013 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7014 @end defmac
7015
7016 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7017 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7018 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7019 of its own that you need to create.
7020
7021 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7022 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7023 described below.
7024 @end deftypefn
7025
7026 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7027 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7028 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7029 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7030 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7031
7032 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7033 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7034 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7035 in read-only sections even in executables.
7036 @end deftypefn
7037
7038 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7039 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7040 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7041 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7042 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7043 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7044 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7045
7046 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7047 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7048
7049 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7050 @end deftypefn
7051
7052 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7053 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7054 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7055
7056 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7057 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7058 it is unlikely to be called.
7059 @end defmac
7060
7061 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7062 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7063 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7064 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7065 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7066
7067 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7068 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7069 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7070 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7071 @end deftypefn
7072
7073 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7074 Return the readonly data section associated with
7075 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7076 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7077 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7078 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7079 otherwise.
7080 @end deftypefn
7081
7082 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7083 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7084 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7085 the string if a different section name should be used.
7086 @end deftypevr
7087
7088 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7089 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7090 @end deftypefn
7091
7092 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7093 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7094 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7095 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7096 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7097 in bits.
7098
7099 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7100 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7101 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7102 @end deftypefn
7103
7104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7105 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7106 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7107 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7108 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7109 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7110 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7111 returns the @var{id} provided.
7112 @end deftypefn
7113
7114 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7115 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7116 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7117 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7118
7119 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7120 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7121 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7122 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7123 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7124
7125 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7126 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7127 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7128 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7129 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7130 leave it alone.)
7131
7132 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7133 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7134 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7135 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7136 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7137 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7138
7139 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7140 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7141 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7142 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7143 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7144 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7145
7146 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7147 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7148 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7149 before overriding it.
7150 @end deftypefn
7151
7152 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7153 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7154 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7155 may have added.
7156 @end deftypefn
7157
7158 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7159 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7160 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7161 @end deftypefn
7162
7163 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7164 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7165 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7166 @end deftypevr
7167
7168 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7169 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7170
7171 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7172 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7173 @end deftypefn
7174
7175 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7176 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7177 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7178 or executable image).
7179
7180 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7181 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7182 currently supported object file formats.
7183 @end deftypefn
7184
7185 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7186 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7187 The default value is false.
7188 @end deftypevr
7189
7190
7191 @node PIC
7192 @section Position Independent Code
7193 @cindex position independent code
7194 @cindex PIC
7195
7196 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7197 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7198 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7199 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7200 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7201 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7202 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7203 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7204 relative addresses.
7205 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7206 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7207
7208 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7209 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7210 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7211 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7212 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7213 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7214 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7215 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7216 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7217 @end defmac
7218
7219 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7220 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7221 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7222 the default is zero. Do not define
7223 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7224 @end defmac
7225
7226 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7227 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7228 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7229 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7230 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7231 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7232 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7233 position independent code.
7234 @end defmac
7235
7236 @node Assembler Format
7237 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7238
7239 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7240 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7241 instructions do.
7242
7243 @menu
7244 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7245 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7246 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7247 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7248 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7249 and termination routines.
7250 * Macros for Initialization::
7251 Specific macros that control the handling of
7252 initialization and termination routines.
7253 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7254 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7255 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7256 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7257 @end menu
7258
7259 @node File Framework
7260 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7261 @cindex assembler format
7262 @cindex output of assembler code
7263
7264 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7265 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7266
7267 @findex default_file_start
7268 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7269 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7270 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7271 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7272 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7273 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7274 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7275 @end deftypefn
7276
7277 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7278 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7279 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7280 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7281 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7282 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7283 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7284 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7285
7286 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7287 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7288 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7289 @end deftypevr
7290
7291 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7292 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7293 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7294 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7295 this to be done. The default is false.
7296 @end deftypevr
7297
7298 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7299 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7300 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7301 @end deftypefn
7302
7303 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7304 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7305 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7306 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7307 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7308 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7309 this function.
7310 @end deftypefun
7311
7312 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7313 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7314 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7315 nothing.
7316 @end deftypefn
7317
7318 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7319 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7320 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7321 nothing.
7322 @end deftypefn
7323
7324 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7325 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7326 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7327 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7328 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7329 nothing.
7330 @end deftypefn
7331
7332 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7333 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7334 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7335 the end of the line.
7336 @end defmac
7337
7338 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7339 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7340 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7341 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7342 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7343 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7344 @end defmac
7345
7346 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7347 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7348 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7349 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7350 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7351 @end defmac
7352
7353 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7354 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7355 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7356 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7357
7358 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7359 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7360 @end defmac
7361
7362 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7363 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7364
7365 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7366 @end deftypefn
7367
7368 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7369 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7370 @end deftypefn
7371
7372 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7373 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7374 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7375 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7376 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7377 of the filename using this macro.
7378 @end defmac
7379
7380 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7381 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7382 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7383 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7384 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7385 this section is associated.
7386 @end deftypefn
7387
7388 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7389 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7390 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7391 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7392 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7393 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7394 (from static destructors).
7395 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7396 @end deftypefn
7397
7398 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7399 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7400 @end deftypefn
7401
7402 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7403 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7404 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7405 @end deftypevr
7406
7407 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7408 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7409 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7410 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7411 This is true on most ELF targets.
7412 @end deftypevr
7413
7414 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7415 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7416 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7417 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7418 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7419
7420 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7421 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7422 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7423 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7424 @end deftypefn
7425
7426 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7427 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7428 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7429 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7430 It can take the following values:
7431
7432 @table @gcctabopt
7433 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7434 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7435
7436 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7437 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7438 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7439 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7440 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7441 various different individual optimization passes.
7442
7443 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7444 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7445 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7446 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7447 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7448 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7449 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7450 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7451 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7452 switches.
7453
7454 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7455 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7456
7457 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7458 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7459 @end table
7460
7461 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7462 supported in the future.
7463
7464 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7465 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7466 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7467 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7468 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7469 hook.
7470 @end deftypefn
7471
7472 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7473 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7474 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7475 hook.
7476 @end deftypevr
7477
7478 @need 2000
7479 @node Data Output
7480 @subsection Output of Data
7481
7482
7483 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7484 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7485 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7486 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7487 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7488 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7489 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7490 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7491 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7492 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7493 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7494 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7495 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7496 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7497
7498 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7499 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7500 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7501 @end deftypevr
7502
7503 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7504 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7505 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7506 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7507 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7508 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7509 split the object into smaller parts.
7510
7511 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7512 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7513 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7514 @end deftypefn
7515
7516 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7517 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7518 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7519 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7520 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7521
7522 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7523 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7524 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7525 return @code{true}.
7526 @end deftypefn
7527
7528 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7529 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7530 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7531 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7532 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7533
7534 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7535 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7536 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7537 @end defmac
7538
7539 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7540 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7541 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7542 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7543 @end defmac
7544
7545 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7546 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7547 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7548 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7549 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7550 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7551 pool before the function.
7552 @end defmac
7553
7554 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7555 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7556 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7557 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7558 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7559 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7560 immediately after this call.
7561
7562 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7563 not be defined.
7564 @end defmac
7565
7566 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7567 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7568 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7569 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7570
7571 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7572 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7573 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7574 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7575 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7576 alignment.
7577
7578 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7579 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7580 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7581 Here is how to do this:
7582
7583 @smallexample
7584 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7585 @end smallexample
7586
7587 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7588 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7589 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7590
7591 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7592 @end defmac
7593
7594 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7595 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7596 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7597 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7598 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7599 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7600
7601 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7602 define this macro.
7603 @end defmac
7604
7605 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7606 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7607 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7608 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7609 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7610
7611 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7612 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7613 @end defmac
7614
7615 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7616 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7617 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7618 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7619 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7620 @end deftypevr
7621
7622 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7623 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7624
7625 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7626 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7627 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7628 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7629 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7630 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7631 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7632 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7633 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7634 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7635 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7636 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7637 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7638 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7639 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7640 on the host machine.
7641
7642 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7643 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7644 machine's memory.
7645 @end defmac
7646
7647 @node Uninitialized Data
7648 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7649
7650 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7651 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7652
7653 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7654 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7655 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7656 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7657 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7658 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7659 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7660 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7661 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7662 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7663 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7664 an ordinary undefined external.
7665
7666 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7667 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7668 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7669
7670 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7671 common global variables are output.
7672 @end defmac
7673
7674 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7675 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7676 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7677 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7678 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7679 as the number of bits.
7680 @end defmac
7681
7682 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7683 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7684 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7685 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7686 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7687 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7688 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7689 @end defmac
7690
7691 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7692 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7693 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7694 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7695 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7696
7697 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7698 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7699 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7700 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7701 the name, and a newline.
7702
7703 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7704 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7705 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7706 You do not need to do both.
7707
7708 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7709 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7710 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7711 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7712 common in order to save space in the object file.
7713 @end defmac
7714
7715 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7716 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7717 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7718 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7719 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7720
7721 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7722 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7723 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7724
7725 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7726 static variables are output.
7727 @end defmac
7728
7729 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7730 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7731 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7732 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7733 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7734 as the number of bits.
7735 @end defmac
7736
7737 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7738 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7739 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7740 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7741 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7742 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7743 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7744 @end defmac
7745
7746 @node Label Output
7747 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7748
7749 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7750 This is about outputting labels.
7751
7752 @findex assemble_name
7753 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7754 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7755 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7756 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7757 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7758 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7759 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7760 @end defmac
7761
7762 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7763 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7764 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7765 a function.
7766 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7767 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7768 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7769 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7770
7771 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7772 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7773 @end defmac
7774
7775 @findex assemble_name_raw
7776 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7777 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7778 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7779 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7780 that it is more efficient.
7781 @end defmac
7782
7783 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7784 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7785 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7786 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7787 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7788
7789 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7790 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7791 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7792 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7793 define this macro.
7794 @end defmac
7795
7796 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7797 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7798 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7799 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7800 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7801 provided.
7802 @end defmac
7803
7804 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7805 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7806 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7807 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7808 address.
7809
7810 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7811 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7812 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7813 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7814 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7815 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7816 @end defmac
7817
7818 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7819 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7820 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7821 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7822 @samp{.} is used instead.
7823 @end defmac
7824
7825 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7826 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7827 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7828 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7829 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7830 @end defmac
7831
7832 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7833 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7834 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7835 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7836 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7837
7838 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7839 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7840 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7841 types at all, do not define this macro.
7842 @end defmac
7843
7844 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7845 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7846 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7847 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7848 the default is not to define this macro.
7849
7850 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7851 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7852 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7853 types at all, do not define this macro.
7854 @end defmac
7855
7856 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7857 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7858 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7859 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7860 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7861 you should not count on this.
7862
7863 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7864 definition of this macro is provided.
7865 @end defmac
7866
7867 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7868 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7869 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7870 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7871 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7872 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7873 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7874
7875 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7876 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7877
7878 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7879 of this macro.
7880 @end defmac
7881
7882 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7883 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7884 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7885 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7886 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7887 representing the function.
7888
7889 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7890
7891 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7892 of this macro.
7893 @end defmac
7894
7895 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7896 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7897 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7898 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7899 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7900 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7901
7902 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7903 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7904
7905 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7906 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7907 @end defmac
7908
7909 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7910 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7911 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7912 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7913 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7914 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7915 will be an internal label.
7916
7917 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7918 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7919
7920 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7921 @end deftypefn
7922
7923 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7924 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7925 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7926 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7927
7928 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7929 nothing.
7930 @end defmac
7931
7932 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7933 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7934 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7935 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7936 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7937 something about the size of the object.
7938
7939 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7940 nothing.
7941
7942 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7943 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7944 @end defmac
7945
7946 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7947 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7948 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7949 that is, available for reference from other files.
7950
7951 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7952 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7953 @end deftypefn
7954
7955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7956 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7957 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7958 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7959
7960 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7961 @end deftypefn
7962
7963 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7964 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7965 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7966 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7967 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7968 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7969 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7970 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7971
7972 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7973 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7974 macro.
7975 @end defmac
7976
7977 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7978 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7979 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7980 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7981 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7982 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7983 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7984 to make @var{name} weak.
7985 @end defmac
7986
7987 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7988 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7989 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7990 declaration of @code{name}.
7991 @end defmac
7992
7993 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7994 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7995 supports weak symbols.
7996
7997 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7998 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7999 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8000 @end defmac
8001
8002 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8003 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8004
8005 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8006 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8007 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8008 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8009 @end defmac
8010
8011 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8012 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8013 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8014 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8015 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8016 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8017 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8018 @end defmac
8019
8020 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8021 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8022 semantics.
8023
8024 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8025 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8026 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8027 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8028 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8029 be emitted as one-only.
8030 @end defmac
8031
8032 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8033 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8034 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8035 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8036 @end deftypefn
8037
8038 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8039 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8040 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8041 The default is @code{0}.
8042
8043 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8044 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8045 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8046 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8047 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8048 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8049 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8050
8051 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8052 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8053 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8054 table of contents.
8055 @end defmac
8056
8057 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8058 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8059 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8060 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8061 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8062 declaration.
8063
8064 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8065 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8066 @end defmac
8067
8068 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8069 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8070 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8071 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8072 @end deftypefn
8073
8074 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8075 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8076 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8077 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8078 @end deftypefn
8079
8080 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8081 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8082 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8083 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8084 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8085 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8086 @end defmac
8087
8088 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8089 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8090 @end deftypefn
8091
8092 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8093 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8094 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8095 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8096 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8097 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8098 @end defmac
8099
8100 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8101 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8102 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8103 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8104 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8105 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8106 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8107 being taken.
8108 @end defmac
8109
8110 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8111 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8112 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8113
8114 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8115 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8116 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8117
8118 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8119 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8120 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8121 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8122 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8123
8124 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8125 @end deftypefn
8126
8127 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8128 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8129 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8130 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8131 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8132 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8133 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8134 bundles.
8135
8136 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8137 used.
8138 @end defmac
8139
8140 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8141 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8142 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8143
8144 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8145 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8146 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8147
8148 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8149 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8150 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8151 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8152 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8153 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8154 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8155 @end defmac
8156
8157 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8158 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8159 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8160 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8161 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8162
8163 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8164 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8165 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8166 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8167 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8168 internal static variables in different scopes.
8169
8170 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8171 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8172 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8173 between the name and the number will suffice.
8174
8175 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8176 which is correct for most systems.
8177 @end defmac
8178
8179 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8180 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8181 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8182
8183 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8184 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8185 correct for most systems.
8186 @end defmac
8187
8188 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8189 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8190 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8191 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8192 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8193 the tree nodes are available.
8194
8195 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8196 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8197 correct for most systems.
8198 @end defmac
8199
8200 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8201 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8202 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8203 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8204 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8205 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8206 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8207 @end defmac
8208
8209 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8210 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8211 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8212 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8213 an undefined weak symbol.
8214
8215 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8216 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8217 @end defmac
8218
8219 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8220 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8221 Objective-C methods.
8222
8223 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8224 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8225 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8226 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8227
8228 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8229 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8230 systems define other ways of computing names.
8231
8232 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8233 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8234 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8235 50 characters extra.
8236
8237 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8238 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8239 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8240 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8241
8242 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8243 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8244 @end defmac
8245
8246 @node Initialization
8247 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8248 @cindex initialization routines
8249 @cindex termination routines
8250 @cindex constructors, output of
8251 @cindex destructors, output of
8252
8253 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8254 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8255 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8256 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8257 @code{main} is called.
8258
8259 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8260 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8261 terminates.
8262
8263 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8264 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8265 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8266 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8267
8268 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8269 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8270 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8271
8272 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8273 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8274 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8275 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8276 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8277
8278 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8279 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8280 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8281 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8282 pointer containing zero.
8283
8284 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8285 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8286 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8287 list; destructors in forward order.
8288
8289 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8290 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8291 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8292 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8293 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8294 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8295 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8296 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8297
8298 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8299 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8300 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8301 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8302 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8303
8304 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8305 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8306 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8307 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8308 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8309
8310 @smallexample
8311 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8312 @end smallexample
8313
8314 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8315 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8316 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8317 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8318 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8319
8320 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8321 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8322 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8323 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8324 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8325 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8326
8327 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8328 macro properly.
8329
8330 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8331 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8332 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8333 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8334 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8335 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8336
8337 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8338 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8339 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8340 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8341 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8342 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8343 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8344 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8345 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8346 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8347 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8348 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8349 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8350 the initialization process.
8351
8352 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8353 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8354 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8355 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8356 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8357 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8358 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8359 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8360 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8361 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8362 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8363
8364 @ifinfo
8365 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8366 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8367 @end ifinfo
8368
8369 @node Macros for Initialization
8370 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8371
8372 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8373 and termination functions:
8374
8375 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8376 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8377 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8378 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8379 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8380 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8381 run the initialization functions.
8382 @end defmac
8383
8384 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8385 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8386 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8387 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8388 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8389 @end defmac
8390
8391 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8392 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8393 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8394 @end defmac
8395
8396 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8397 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8398 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8399 @end defmac
8400
8401 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8402 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8403 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8404 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8405 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8406 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8407
8408 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8409 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8410 exception tables embedded in the code.
8411 @end defmac
8412
8413 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8414 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8415 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8416 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8417 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8418 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8419 @end defmac
8420
8421 @defmac INVOKE__main
8422 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8423 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8424 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8425 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8426 @end defmac
8427
8428 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8429 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8430 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8431 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8432 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8433 @end defmac
8434
8435 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8436 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8437 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8438 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8439 @end deftypevr
8440
8441 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8442 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8443 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8444
8445 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8446 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8447 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8448 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8449
8450 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8451 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8452 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8453 is not defined.
8454 @end deftypefn
8455
8456 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8457 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8458 functions rather than initialization functions.
8459 @end deftypefn
8460
8461 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8462 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8463
8464 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8465 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8466 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8467
8468 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8469 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8470
8471 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8472 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8473 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8474 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8475
8476 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8477 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8478 @end defmac
8479
8480 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8481 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8482 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8483 @command{nm}.
8484 @end defmac
8485
8486 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8487 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8488 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8489 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8490 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8491 produces.
8492 @end defmac
8493
8494 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8495 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8496 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8497 termination functions in shared libraries:
8498
8499 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8500 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8501 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8502 @end defmac
8503
8504 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8505 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8506 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8507 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8508 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8509 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8510 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8511 @end defmac
8512
8513 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8514 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8515 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8516 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8517 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8518 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8519 @end defmac
8520
8521 @node Instruction Output
8522 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8523
8524 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8525 This describes assembler instruction output.
8526
8527 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8528 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8529 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8530 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8531 @end defmac
8532
8533 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8534 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8535 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8536 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8537 to registers using alternate names.
8538 @end defmac
8539
8540 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8541 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8542 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8543 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8544 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8545 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8546 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8547 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8548
8549 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8550 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8551 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8552 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8553 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8554 @end defmac
8555
8556 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8557 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8558 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8559
8560 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8561 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8562 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8563 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8564 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8565 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8566 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8567 so that it will not be output twice.
8568
8569 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8570 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8571 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8572 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8573 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8574
8575 @findex recog_data.operand
8576 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8577 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8578
8579 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8580 in the usual way.
8581 @end defmac
8582
8583 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8584 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8585 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8586 they will be output differently.
8587
8588 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8589 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8590 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8591 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8592 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8593 by changing the contents of the vector.
8594
8595 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8596 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8597 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8598 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8599 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8600 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8601
8602 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8603 @end defmac
8604
8605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8606 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8607 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8608 if necessary.
8609
8610 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8611 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8612 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8613 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8614 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8615 by checking the contents of the vector.
8616 @end deftypefn
8617
8618 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8619 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8620 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8621 RTL expression.
8622
8623 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8624 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8625 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8626 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8627 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8628 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8629 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8630
8631 @findex reg_names
8632 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8633 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8634 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8635 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8636
8637 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8638 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8639 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8640 @var{code}.
8641 @end defmac
8642
8643 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8644 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8645 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8646 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8647 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8648 in this way.
8649 @end defmac
8650
8651 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8652 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8653 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8654 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8655
8656 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8657 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8658 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8659 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8660 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8661 Format}.
8662 @end defmac
8663
8664 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8665 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8666 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8667 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8668 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8669 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8670 or whatever.
8671
8672 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8673 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8674 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8675 @end defmac
8676
8677 @findex final_sequence
8678 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8679 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8680 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8681 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8682 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8683 being output.
8684
8685 @findex asm_fprintf
8686 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8687 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8688 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8689 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8690 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8691 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8692 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8693 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8694 files can define these macros differently.
8695 @end defmac
8696
8697 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8698 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8699 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8700 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8701 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8702 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8703 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8704 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8705 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8706 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8707 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8708 @end defmac
8709
8710 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8711 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8712 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8713 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8714 first variant.
8715
8716 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8717 @smallexample
8718 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8719 @end smallexample
8720 @noindent
8721 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8722 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8723 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8724 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8725 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8726 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8727 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8728
8729 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8730 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8731 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8732
8733 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8734 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8735 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8736 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8737 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8738 opcodes or operand order.
8739 @end defmac
8740
8741 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8742 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8743 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8744 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8745 profiling.
8746 @end defmac
8747
8748 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8749 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8750 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8751 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8752 profiling.
8753 @end defmac
8754
8755 @node Dispatch Tables
8756 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8757
8758 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8759 This concerns dispatch tables.
8760
8761 @cindex dispatch table
8762 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8763 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8764 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8765 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8766 definitions of these labels are output using
8767 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8768 way here. For example,
8769
8770 @smallexample
8771 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8772 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8773 @end smallexample
8774
8775 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8776 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8777 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8778 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8779 mode and flags can be read.
8780 @end defmac
8781
8782 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8783 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8784 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8785
8786 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8787 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8788 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8789 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8790 For example,
8791
8792 @smallexample
8793 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8794 @end smallexample
8795 @end defmac
8796
8797 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8798 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8799 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8800 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8801 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8802 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8803
8804 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8805 for the table.
8806
8807 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8808 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8809 @end defmac
8810
8811 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8812 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8813 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8814 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8815 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8816 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8817 of the preceding label.
8818
8819 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8820 the jump-table.
8821 @end defmac
8822
8823 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8824 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8825 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8826 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8827 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8828 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8829 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8830 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8831
8832 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8833 @end deftypefn
8834
8835 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8836 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8837 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8838 to be broken up according to function.
8839
8840 The default is that no label is emitted.
8841 @end deftypefn
8842
8843 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8844 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8845 @end deftypefn
8846
8847 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
8848 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8849 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8850 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8851 @end deftypefn
8852
8853 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8854 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8855 @end deftypevr
8856
8857 @node Exception Region Output
8858 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8859
8860 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8861
8862 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8863 region.
8864
8865 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8866 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8867 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8868 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8869 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8870
8871 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8872 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8873 @end defmac
8874
8875 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8876 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8877 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8878 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8879 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8880
8881 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8882 also defined.
8883 @end defmac
8884
8885 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8886 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8887 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8888 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8889 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8890 @end defmac
8891
8892 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8893 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8894 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8895 @end defmac
8896
8897 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8898 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8899 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8900 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8901 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8902 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8903 @end defmac
8904
8905 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
8906 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8907 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8908 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8909 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8910 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8911 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8912
8913 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8914 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8915 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8916
8917 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8918 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8919 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8920 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8921 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8922 depending on this setting.
8923
8924 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8925 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8926 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8927 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8928 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8929 @end deftypefn
8930
8931 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8932 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8933 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8934 command-line option processing.
8935 @end deftypevr
8936
8937 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8938 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8939 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8940 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8941 @end defmac
8942
8943 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
8944 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
8945 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
8946 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
8947 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
8948 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
8949 @end defmac
8950
8951 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8952 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8953 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8954 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8955 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8956 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8957 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8958 @end defmac
8959
8960 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8961 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8962 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8963 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8964 true otherwise.
8965 @end deftypevr
8966
8967 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8968 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8969 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8970 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8971 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8972 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8973 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8974 @end deftypefn
8975
8976 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8977 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8978 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8979 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8980 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8981 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8982 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8983 @end deftypefn
8984
8985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
8986 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8987 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8988 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8989 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8990 @end deftypefn
8991
8992 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8993 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8994 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8995 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8996 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8997 @end deftypevr
8998
8999 @node Alignment Output
9000 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9001
9002 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9003 This describes commands for alignment.
9004
9005 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9006 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9007 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9008
9009 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9010 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9011 define the macro.
9012
9013 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9014 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9015 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9016 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9017 @end defmac
9018
9019 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9020 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9021 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9022 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9023 @end deftypefn
9024
9025 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9026 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9027 a @code{BARRIER}.
9028
9029 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9030 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9031 define the macro.
9032 @end defmac
9033
9034 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9035 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9036 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9037 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9038 @end deftypefn
9039
9040 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9041 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9042 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
9043
9044 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9045 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9046 define the macro.
9047
9048 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9049 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9050 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9051 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9052 @end defmac
9053
9054 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9055 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9056 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9057 defined.
9058 @end deftypefn
9059
9060 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9061 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9062 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9063 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9064
9065 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9066 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9067 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9068 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9069 @end defmac
9070
9071 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9072 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9073 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9074 is defined.
9075 @end deftypefn
9076
9077 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9078 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9079 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9080 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9081 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9082 @end defmac
9083
9084 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9085 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9086 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9087 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9088 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9089 section.
9090 @end defmac
9091
9092 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9093 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9094 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9095 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9096 @end defmac
9097
9098 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9099 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9100 for padding, if necessary.
9101 @end defmac
9102
9103 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9104 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9105 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9106 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9107 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9108 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9109 @end defmac
9110
9111 @need 3000
9112 @node Debugging Info
9113 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9114
9115 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9116 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9117
9118 @menu
9119 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9120 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9121 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9122 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9123 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9124 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9125 @end menu
9126
9127 @node All Debuggers
9128 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9129
9130 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9131 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9132
9133 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9134 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9135 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9136 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9137 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9138 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9139 compiler and another for DBX@.
9140
9141 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9142 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9143 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9144 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9145 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9146
9147 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9148 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9149 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9150 @end defmac
9151
9152 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9153 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9154 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9155 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9156 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9157 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9158 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9159 @option{-g} options is used.
9160 @end defmac
9161
9162 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9163 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9164 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9165 @var{offset}.
9166 @end defmac
9167
9168 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9169 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9170 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9171 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9172 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9173 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9174 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9175
9176 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9177 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9178 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9179 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9180 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9181
9182 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9183 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9184 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9185 @end defmac
9186
9187 @node DBX Options
9188 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9189
9190 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9191 These are specific options for DBX output.
9192
9193 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9194 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9195 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9196 @end defmac
9197
9198 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9199 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9200 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9201 @end defmac
9202
9203 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9204 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9205 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9206 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9207 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9208 if there is any occasion to.
9209 @end defmac
9210
9211 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9212 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9213 in the text section.
9214 @end defmac
9215
9216 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9217 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9218 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9219 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9220 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9221 @end defmac
9222
9223 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9224 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9225 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9226 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9227 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9228 information format.
9229 @end defmac
9230
9231 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9232 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9233 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9234 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9235 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9236 @end defmac
9237
9238 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9239 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9240 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9241 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9242 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9243 @end defmac
9244
9245 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9246 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9247 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9248 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9249 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9250 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9251 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9252 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9253 @end defmac
9254
9255 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9256 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9257 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9258 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9259 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9260 if backslash is correct for your system.
9261 @end defmac
9262
9263 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9264 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9265 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9266 variable.
9267 @end defmac
9268
9269 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9270 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9271 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9272 @end defmac
9273
9274 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9275 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9276 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9277 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9278 @end defmac
9279
9280 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9281 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9282 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9283 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9284 @end defmac
9285
9286 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9287 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9288 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9289 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9290 @end defmac
9291
9292 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9293 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9294 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9295 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9296 code.
9297 @end defmac
9298
9299 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9300 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9301 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9302 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9303 an absolute address.
9304 @end defmac
9305
9306 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9307 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9308 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9309 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9310 @end defmac
9311
9312 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9313 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9314 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9315 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9316 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9317 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9318 number for a type number.
9319 @end defmac
9320
9321 @node DBX Hooks
9322 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9323
9324 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9325 These are hooks for DBX format.
9326
9327 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9328 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9329 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9330 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9331 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9332 unique labels in the assembly output.
9333
9334 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9335 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9336 @end defmac
9337
9338 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9339 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9340 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9341 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9342 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9343 @end defmac
9344
9345 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9346 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9347 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9348 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9349 @end defmac
9350
9351 @node File Names and DBX
9352 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9353
9354 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9355 This describes file names in DBX format.
9356
9357 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9358 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9359 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9360 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9361 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9362
9363 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9364 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9365
9366 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9367 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9368 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9369 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9370 @end defmac
9371
9372 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9373 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9374 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9375 the beginning of the file.
9376 @end defmac
9377
9378 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9379 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9380 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9381 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9382 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9383 @end defmac
9384
9385 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9386 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9387 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9388 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9389
9390 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9391 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9392 @end defmac
9393
9394 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9395 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9396 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9397 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9398 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9399 @end defmac
9400
9401 @need 2000
9402 @node SDB and DWARF
9403 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9404
9405 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9406 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9407
9408 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9409 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9410 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9411 @end defmac
9412
9413 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9414 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9415 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9416
9417 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9418 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9419 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9420 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9421 @end deftypefn
9422
9423 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9424 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9425 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9426 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9427 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9428 @end defmac
9429
9430 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9431 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9432 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9433 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9434 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9435 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9436 @end defmac
9437
9438 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9439 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9440 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9441 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9442 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9443
9444 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9445 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9446
9447 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9448 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9449 @end deftypefn
9450
9451 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9452 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9453 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9454 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9455 @end defmac
9456
9457 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9458 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9459 @end deftypevr
9460
9461 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9462 True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9463 @end deftypevr
9464
9465 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9466 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9467 @end deftypevr
9468
9469 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9470 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9471 @end deftypevr
9472
9473 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9474 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9475 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9476 @end defmac
9477
9478 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9479 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9480 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9481 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9482 @end defmac
9483
9484 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9485 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9486 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9487 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9488 @end defmac
9489
9490 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9491 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9492 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9493 @end defmac
9494
9495 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9496 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9497 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9498 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9499 is referenced by a function.
9500 @end defmac
9501
9502 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9503 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9504 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9505 @end deftypefn
9506
9507 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9508 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9509 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9510 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9511 not define them yourself.
9512 @end defmac
9513
9514 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9515 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9516 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9517 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9518 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9519 required.
9520 @end defmac
9521
9522 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9523 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9524 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9525 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9526 it.
9527 @end defmac
9528
9529 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9530 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9531 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9532 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9533 @end defmac
9534
9535 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9536 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9537 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9538 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9539 @end defmac
9540
9541 @need 2000
9542 @node VMS Debug
9543 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9544
9545 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9546 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9547
9548 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9549 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9550 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9551 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9552 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9553 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9554 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9555 @end defmac
9556
9557 @node Floating Point
9558 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9559 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9560 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9561
9562 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9563 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9564 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9565 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9566 doing the compilation.
9567
9568 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9569 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9570 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9571 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9572 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9573 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9574 target floating point formats are identical.
9575
9576 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9577 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9578 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9579 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9580
9581 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9582 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9583 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9584 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9585 quantity.
9586 @end defmac
9587
9588 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9589 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9590 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9591 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9592 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9593 @end deftypefn
9594
9595 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9596 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9597 @end deftypefn
9598
9599 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9600 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9601 @end deftypefn
9602
9603 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9604 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9605 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9606 @end deftypefn
9607
9608 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9609 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9610 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9611 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9612 defined by the C language for both.
9613 @end deftypefn
9614
9615 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9616 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9617 @end deftypefn
9618
9619 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9620 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9621 @end deftypefn
9622
9623 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9624 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9625 @end deftypefn
9626
9627 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9628 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9629 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9630 variable).
9631
9632 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9633 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9634 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9635
9636 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9637 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9638 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9639 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9640 @end deftypefn
9641
9642 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9643 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9644 @end deftypefn
9645
9646 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9647 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9648 @end deftypefn
9649
9650 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9651 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9652 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9653 integral, it is truncated.
9654 @end deftypefn
9655
9656 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9657 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9658 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9659 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9660 @end deftypefn
9661
9662 @node Mode Switching
9663 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9664 @cindex mode switching
9665 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9666
9667 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9668 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9669 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9670
9671 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9672 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9673 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9674 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9675 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9676 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9677 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9678
9679 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9680 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9681 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9682 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9683 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9684 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9685 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9686 are optional.
9687 @end defmac
9688
9689 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9690 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9691 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9692 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9693 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9694 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9695 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9696 entity in question.
9697 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9698 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9699 switch is needed / supplied.
9700 @end defmac
9701
9702 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9703 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9704 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9705 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9706 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9707 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9708 @end defmac
9709
9710 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{insn})
9711 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9712 this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9713 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9714 different from the incoming mode).
9715 @end defmac
9716
9717 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9718 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9719 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9720 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9721 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9722 @end defmac
9723
9724 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9725 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9726 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9727 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9728 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9729 @end defmac
9730
9731 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9732 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9733 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9734 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9735 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9736 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9737 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9738 @end defmac
9739
9740 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9741 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9742 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9743 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9744 @end defmac
9745
9746 @node Target Attributes
9747 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9748 @cindex target attributes
9749 @cindex machine attributes
9750 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9751
9752 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9753 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9754 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9755
9756 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9757 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9758 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9759 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9760 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9761 take.
9762 @end deftypevr
9763
9764 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9765 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9766 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9767 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9768 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9769 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9770 @end deftypefn
9771
9772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9773 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9774 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9775 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9776 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9777 supposed always to be compatible.
9778 @end deftypefn
9779
9780 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9781 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9782 the newly defined @var{type}.
9783 @end deftypefn
9784
9785 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9786 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9787 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9788 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9789 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9790 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9791 merging.
9792 @end deftypefn
9793
9794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9795 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9796 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9797 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9798 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9799 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9800 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9801 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9802
9803 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9804 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9805 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9806 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9807 will then define a function called
9808 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9809 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9810 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9811 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9812 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9813 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9814 @end deftypefn
9815
9816 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9817 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9818 @end deftypefn
9819
9820 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9821 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9822 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9823 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9824 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9825 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9826 on this implementation detail.
9827 @end defmac
9828
9829 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9830 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9831 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9832 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9833 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9834 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9835 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9836 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9837 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9838 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9839 needed.
9840 @end deftypefn
9841
9842 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9843 @cindex inlining
9844 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9845 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9846 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9847 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9848 @end deftypefn
9849
9850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9851 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
9852 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
9853 These function-specific options may differ
9854 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9855 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9856
9857 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9858 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
9859 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9860 @end deftypefn
9861
9862 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9863 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
9864 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
9865 options.
9866 @xref{Option file format}.
9867 @end deftypefn
9868
9869 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9870 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
9871 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9872 function-specific options.
9873 @end deftypefn
9874
9875 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9876 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
9877 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9878 function-specific options.
9879 @end deftypefn
9880
9881 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9882 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
9883 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
9884 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
9885 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9886 @end deftypefn
9887
9888 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9889 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9890 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9891 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9892 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9893
9894 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9895 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9896
9897 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9898 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9899 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9900 @end deftypefn
9901
9902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
9903 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
9904 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
9905 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
9906 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
9907 different target machines.
9908 @end deftypefn
9909
9910 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9911 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9912 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9913 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9914 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9915 @end deftypefn
9916
9917 @node Emulated TLS
9918 @section Emulating TLS
9919 @cindex Emulated TLS
9920
9921 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9922 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9923 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9924 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9925 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9926 layer.
9927
9928 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9929 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9930 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9931 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9932
9933 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9934 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9935 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9936 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9937 @end deftypevr
9938
9939 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9940 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9941 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9942 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9943 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9944 registration function to be used.
9945 @end deftypevr
9946
9947 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9948 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9949 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9950 any section.
9951 @end deftypevr
9952
9953 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9954 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9955 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9956 section.
9957 @end deftypevr
9958
9959 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9960 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9961 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9962 @end deftypevr
9963
9964 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9965 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9966 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9967 @end deftypevr
9968
9969 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9970 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9971 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9972 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9973 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9974 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9975 @end deftypefn
9976
9977 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
9978 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9979 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9980 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9981 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9982 @end deftypefn
9983
9984 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9985 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9986 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9987 single objects. The default is false.
9988 @end deftypevr
9989
9990 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9991 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9992 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9993 @end deftypevr
9994
9995 @node MIPS Coprocessors
9996 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9997 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9998
9999 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10000 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10001 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10002 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10003
10004 @smallexample
10005 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10006 unsigned int d;
10007
10008 d = cp0count + 3;
10009 @end smallexample
10010
10011 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10012 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10013 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10014
10015 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10016 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10017 later in the function.
10018
10019 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10020 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10021 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10022
10023 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
10024 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
10025
10026 @node PCH Target
10027 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10028 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10029
10030 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10031 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10032 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10033 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10034 @end deftypefn
10035
10036 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10037 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10038 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10039 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10040 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10041
10042 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10043 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10044 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10045 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10046
10047 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10048 suitable for most targets.
10049 @end deftypefn
10050
10051 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10052 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10053 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10054 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10055 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10056 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10057 @end deftypefn
10058
10059 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10060 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10061 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10062 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10063 to do anything here.
10064 @end deftypefn
10065
10066 @node C++ ABI
10067 @section C++ ABI parameters
10068 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10069
10070 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10071 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10072 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10073 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10074 @end deftypefn
10075
10076 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10077 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10078 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10079 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10080 @end deftypefn
10081
10082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10083 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10084 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10085 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10086 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10087 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10088 @end deftypefn
10089
10090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10091 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10092 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10093 @end deftypefn
10094
10095 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10096 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10097 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10098 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10099 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10100 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10101 backend's targeted operating system.
10102 @end deftypefn
10103
10104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10105 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10106 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10107 @code{false}.
10108 @end deftypefn
10109
10110 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10111 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10112 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10113 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10114 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10115 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10116 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10117 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10118 @end deftypefn
10119
10120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10121 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10122 @end deftypefn
10123
10124 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10125 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10126 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10127 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10128 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10129 unit will not be COMDAT.
10130 @end deftypefn
10131
10132 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10133 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10134 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10135 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10136 @end deftypefn
10137
10138 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10139 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10140 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10141 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10142 @end deftypefn
10143
10144 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10145 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10146 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10147 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10148 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10149 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10150 @end deftypefn
10151
10152 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10153 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10154 @end deftypefn
10155
10156 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10157 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10158 @end deftypefn
10159
10160 @node Named Address Spaces
10161 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10162 @cindex named address spaces
10163
10164 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10165 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10166 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10167 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10168 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10169 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10170 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10171 @code{const} type attributes.
10172
10173 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10174 pointers to the generic address space.
10175
10176 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10177 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10178 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10179 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10180 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10181 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10182 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10183 always 32 bits).
10184
10185 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10186 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10187 address space.
10188
10189 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10190 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10191 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10192 named address space #1:
10193 @smallexample
10194 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10195 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10196 @end smallexample
10197
10198 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10199 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10200 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10201 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10202 generic address space only.
10203 @end deftypefn
10204
10205 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10206 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10207 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10208 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10209 generic address space only.
10210 @end deftypefn
10211
10212 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10213 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10214 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10215 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10216 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10217 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10218 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10219 target hooks for the given address space.
10220 @end deftypefn
10221
10222 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10223 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10224 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10225 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10226 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10227 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10228 explicit named address space support.
10229 @end deftypefn
10230
10231 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10232 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10233 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10234 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10235 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10236 @end deftypefn
10237
10238 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10239 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10240 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10241 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10242 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10243 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10244 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10245 @end deftypefn
10246
10247 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10248 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10249 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10250 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10251 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10252 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10253 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10254 @end deftypefn
10255
10256 @node Misc
10257 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10258 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10259
10260 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10261 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10262
10263 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10264 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10265 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10266 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10267 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10268 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10269 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10270 @end defmac
10271
10272 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10273 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10274 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10275 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10276 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10277 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10278 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10279 @end defmac
10280
10281 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10282 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10283 elements of a jump-table should have.
10284 @end defmac
10285
10286 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10287 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10288 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10289 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10290 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10291 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10292 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10293 flags can be updated.
10294 @end defmac
10295
10296 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10297 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10298 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10299 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10300 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10301 is in effect.
10302 @end defmac
10303
10304 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10305 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10306 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10307 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10308 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10309 @end deftypefn
10310
10311 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10312 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10313 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10314 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10315 @end defmac
10316
10317 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10318 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10319 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10320 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10321 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10322 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10323 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10324 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10325
10326 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10327 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10328 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10329 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10330 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10331
10332 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10333 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10334 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10335 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10336 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10337
10338 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10339 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10340 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10341 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10342 @end defmac
10343
10344 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10345 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10346 extends.
10347 @end defmac
10348
10349 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10350 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10351 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10352 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10353 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10354 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10355 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10356 @end deftypefn
10357
10358 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10359 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10360 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10361 @end defmac
10362
10363 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10364 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10365 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10366 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10367 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10368 at run-time.
10369 @end defmac
10370
10371 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10372 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10373 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10374 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10375 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10376 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10377 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10378 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10379 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10380 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10381 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10382
10383 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10384 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10385 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10386
10387 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10388 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10389 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10390 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10391 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10392
10393 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10394 @end defmac
10395
10396 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10397 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10398 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10399 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10400 @xref{shift patterns}.
10401
10402 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10403 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10404 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10405 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10406 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10407 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10408
10409 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10410 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10411 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10412
10413 The default implementation of this function returns
10414 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10415 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10416 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10417 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10418 by overriding it.
10419 @end deftypefn
10420
10421 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10422 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10423 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10424 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10425 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10426
10427 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10428
10429 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10430 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10431 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10432 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10433 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10434 such cases may improve things.
10435 @end defmac
10436
10437 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10438 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10439 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10440 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10441 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10442 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10443 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10444 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10445 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10446 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10447 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10448
10449 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10450 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10451 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10452 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10453
10454 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10455 describe two related properties. If you define
10456 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10457 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10458 extension.
10459
10460 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10461 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10462 @code{mode}.
10463 @end deftypefn
10464
10465 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10466 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10467 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10468 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10469 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10470 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10471
10472 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10473 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10474 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10475 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10476 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10477 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10478 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10479 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10480 the compiler.
10481
10482 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10483 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10484 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10485 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10486 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10487 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10488 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10489 expression
10490
10491 @smallexample
10492 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10493 @end smallexample
10494
10495 @noindent
10496 can be converted to
10497
10498 @smallexample
10499 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10500 @end smallexample
10501
10502 @noindent
10503 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10504 tested into the sign bit.
10505
10506 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10507 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10508 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10509 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10510 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10511 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10512
10513 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10514 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10515 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10516 to be used:
10517
10518 @itemize @bullet
10519 @item
10520 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10521 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10522 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10523 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10524 combine the normalization with other operations.
10525
10526 @item
10527 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10528 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10529 other machines.
10530
10531 @item
10532 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10533 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10534 others.
10535
10536 @item
10537 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10538 @end itemize
10539
10540 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10541 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10542 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10543 those cases, e.g., one matching
10544
10545 @smallexample
10546 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10547 @end smallexample
10548
10549 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10550 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10551 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10552 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10553 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10554 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10555 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10556 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10557
10558 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10559 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10560 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10561 @end defmac
10562
10563 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10564 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10565 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10566 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10567 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10568 this macro.
10569 @end defmac
10570
10571 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10572 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10573 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10574 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10575 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10576 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10577 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10578 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10579 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10580 given mode.
10581 @end defmac
10582
10583 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10584 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10585 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10586 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10587 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10588 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10589 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10590 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10591 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10592 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10593 this value.
10594
10595 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10596 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10597
10598 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10599 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10600 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10601 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10602
10603 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10604 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10605 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10606 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10607 breaking the API@.
10608 @end defmac
10609
10610 @defmac Pmode
10611 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10612 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10613 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10614 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10615 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10616
10617 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10618 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10619 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10620 to @code{Pmode}.
10621 @end defmac
10622
10623 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10624 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10625 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10626 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10627 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10628 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10629 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10630 @end defmac
10631
10632 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10633 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10634 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10635 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10636 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10637 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10638
10639 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10640 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10641 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10642 @end defmac
10643
10644 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10645 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10646
10647 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10648 @end deftypefn
10649
10650 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10651 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10652 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10653 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10654 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10655 @end defmac
10656
10657 @findex #pragma
10658 @findex pragma
10659 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10660 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10661 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10662 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10663 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10664 setup required for the pragmas.
10665
10666 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10667 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10668 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10669
10670 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10671 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10672
10673 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10674 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10675 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10676 @end defmac
10677
10678 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10679 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10680
10681 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10682 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10683 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10684 pragma of the form
10685
10686 @smallexample
10687 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10688 @end smallexample
10689
10690 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10691 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10692 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10693 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10694 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10695 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10696 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10697 arguments of pragmas registered with
10698 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10699 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10700
10701 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10702 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10703 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10704 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10705 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10706 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10707 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10708 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10709 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10710 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10711 how to build this object file.
10712 @end deftypefun
10713
10714 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10715 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10716 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10717 @end defmac
10718
10719 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10720 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10721 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10722 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10723 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10724 @end defmac
10725
10726 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10727 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10728 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10729 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10730 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10731 @end defmac
10732
10733 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10734 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10735 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10736 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10737 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10738 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10739 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10740 you should define this macro.
10741
10742 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10743 @end defmac
10744
10745 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10746 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10747 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10748 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10749 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10750 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10751 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10752 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10753 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10754 slot of @var{insn}.
10755
10756 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10757 @end defmac
10758
10759 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10760 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10761 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10762 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10763 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10764 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10765
10766 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10767 @end defmac
10768
10769 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
10770 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10771 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10772 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10773 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10774 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10775 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10776 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10777 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10778 @end deftypefn
10779
10780 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10781 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10782 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10783 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10784 separate math library.
10785
10786 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10787 @end defmac
10788
10789 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10790 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10791 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10792
10793 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10794 is wrong.
10795 @end defmac
10796
10797 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10798 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10799 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10800 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10801 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10802 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10803 for cross-profiling.
10804 @end defmac
10805
10806 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10807
10808 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10809 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10810 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10811 1 if it does use cc0.
10812 @end defmac
10813
10814 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10815 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10816 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10817 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10818 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10819 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10820 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10821 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10822 @end defmac
10823
10824 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10825 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10826 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10827 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10828 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10829 @end defmac
10830
10831 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10832 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10833 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10834 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10835 about the currently processed blocks.
10836 @end defmac
10837
10838 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10839 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10840 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10841 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10842 to by @var{ce_info}.
10843 @end defmac
10844
10845 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10846 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10847 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10848 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10849 to by @var{ce_info}.
10850 @end defmac
10851
10852 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10853 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10854 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10855 to by @var{ce_info}.
10856 @end defmac
10857
10858 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10859 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10860 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10861 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10862
10863 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10864 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10865 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10866 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10867
10868 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10869 definition is null.
10870 @end deftypefn
10871
10872 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10873 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10874 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10875 necessary setup.
10876
10877 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10878 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10879 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10880 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10881
10882 To create a built-in function, call the function
10883 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10884 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10885 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
10886 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10887 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10888 @end deftypefn
10889
10890 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10891 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10892 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10893 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10894 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10895 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10896 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10897 @code{error_mark_node}.
10898 @end deftypefn
10899
10900 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10901
10902 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10903 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10904 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10905 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10906 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10907 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10908 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10909 built-in function.
10910 @end deftypefn
10911
10912 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10913 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10914 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10915 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10916 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10917 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10918 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10919 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10920 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10921 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10922 @end deftypefn
10923
10924 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10925 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10926 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10927 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10928 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10929 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10930 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10931 @end deftypefn
10932
10933 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10934 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
10935 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
10936 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
10937 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
10938 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
10939 the two function decls that will be compared.
10940 @end deftypefn
10941
10942 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
10943 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
10944 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
10945 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
10946 identical versions.
10947 @end deftypefn
10948
10949 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
10950 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
10951 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
10952 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
10953 body must be generated.
10954 @end deftypefn
10955
10956 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
10957
10958 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10959 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10960 could not be applied.
10961
10962 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10963 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10964 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10965 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10966 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10967 @end deftypefn
10968
10969 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx @var{insn})
10970 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
10971 @end deftypefn
10972
10973 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10974
10975 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10976 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10977 @var{branch2} is possible.
10978
10979 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10980 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10981 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10982 @end defmac
10983
10984 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const_rtx @var{follower}, const_rtx @var{followee})
10985 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
10986 @end deftypefn
10987
10988 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
10989 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10990 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10991 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10992 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10993 @end deftypefn
10994
10995 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
10996
10997 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10998 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10999 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11000 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11001 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11002 that had its initial value copied by using
11003 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11004 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11005 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11006 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11007 @code{MEM}.
11008 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11009 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11010 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11011 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11012 register in question will not be clobbered.
11013 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11014 allocation.
11015 @end deftypefn
11016
11017 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11018 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11019 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11020 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11021 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11022 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11023 passed along.
11024 @end deftypefn
11025
11026 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11027 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11028 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11029 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11030 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11031 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11032 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11033 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11034 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11035 The default hook function does nothing.
11036
11037 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11038 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11039 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11040 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11041 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11042 outside of any function scope.
11043 @end deftypefn
11044
11045 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11046 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11047 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11048 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11049 @end defmac
11050
11051 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11052 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11053 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11054 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11055 executable files.
11056 @end defmac
11057
11058 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11059 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11060 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11061 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11062 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11063 lists.
11064 @end defmac
11065
11066 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11067 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11068 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11069 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11070 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11071 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11072 defined as this expression:
11073
11074 @smallexample
11075 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11076 build_tree_list
11077 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11078 NULL))
11079 @end smallexample
11080 @end defmac
11081
11082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11083 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11084 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11085 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11086 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11087
11088 @smallexample
11089 static bool
11090 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11091 @{
11092 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11093 @}
11094 @end smallexample
11095 @end deftypefn
11096
11097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11098 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11099 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11100 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11101 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11102 to inter-block scheduling.
11103 @end deftypefn
11104
11105 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11106 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11107 registers
11108 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11109 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11110 that all target registers in the class returned by
11111 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11112 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11113 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11114 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11115 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11116 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11117 @end deftypefn
11118
11119 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11120 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11121 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11122 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11123 @end deftypefn
11124
11125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11126 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11127 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11128 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11129 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11130 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11131 number of memory accesses.
11132 @end deftypefn
11133
11134 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11135 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11136 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11137 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11138 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11139 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11140 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11141 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11142 @end defmac
11143
11144 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11145 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11146 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11147 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11148 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11149 @end deftypefn
11150
11151 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11152 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11153 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11154 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11155 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11156 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11157 @end deftypefn
11158
11159 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11160 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11161 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11162 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11163 that are different from @option{-I}.
11164 @end deftypefn
11165
11166 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11167 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11168 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11169 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11170 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11171 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11172 @end defmac
11173
11174 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11175 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11176 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11177 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11178 @end defmac
11179
11180 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11181 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11182 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11183 @end defmac
11184
11185 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11186 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11187 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11188 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11189 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11190 @end defmac
11191
11192 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11193 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11194 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11195 @end defmac
11196
11197 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11198 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11199 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11200 and scanf formatter settings.
11201 @end defmac
11202
11203 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11204 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11205 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11206 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11207 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11208 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11209 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11210 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11211 @end deftypevr
11212
11213 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11214 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11215 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11216 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11217 @end deftypefn
11218
11219 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11220 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11221 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11222 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11223 @end deftypefn
11224
11225 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11226 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11227 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11228 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11229 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11230 @end deftypefn
11231
11232 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11233 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11234 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11235 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11236 the front end.
11237 @end deftypefn
11238
11239 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11240 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11241 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11242 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11243 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11244 @end deftypefn
11245
11246 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11247 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11248 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11249 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11250 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11251 @end deftypefn
11252
11253 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11254 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11255 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11256 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11257 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11258 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11259 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11260 @end deftypefn
11261
11262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11263 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11264 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11265 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11266 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11267 conversion rules.
11268 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11269 @end deftypefn
11270
11271 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11272 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11273 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11274 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11275 @end defmac
11276
11277 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11278 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11279 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11280 @end defmac
11281
11282 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11283 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11284 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11285 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11286 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11287 @end defmac
11288
11289 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11290 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11291 necessary.
11292 @end deftypefn
11293
11294 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11295 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11296 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11297 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11298 is needed.
11299 @end deftypefn
11300
11301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11302 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11303 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11304 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11305 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11306 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11307 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11308 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11309 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11310 @end deftypefn
11311
11312 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11313 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11314 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11315 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11316 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11317 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11318 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11319 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11320 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11321 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11322 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11323 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11324 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11325 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11326 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11327 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11328 @end deftypevr
11329
11330 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11331 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11332 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11333 supported by the target.
11334 @end deftypefn
11335
11336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11337 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11338 memory model bits are allowed.
11339 @end deftypefn
11340
11341 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11342 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11343 @end deftypevr
11344
11345 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11346 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11347 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11348 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11349 @end deftypefn